Bulletin 857 Protection System For Feeder and Motor Protection, Series A
Bulletin 857 Protection System For Feeder and Motor Protection, Series A
Original Instructions
Activities including installation, adjustments, putting into service, use, assembly, disassembly, and maintenance are
required to be carried out by suitably trained personnel in accordance with applicable code of practice.
If this equipment is used in a manner not specified by the manufacturer, the protection provided by the equipment may
be impaired.
In no event will Rockwell Automation, Inc. be responsible or liable for indirect or consequential damages resulting from
the use or application of this equipment.
The examples and diagrams in this manual are included solely for illustrative purposes. Because of the many variables and
requirements associated with any particular installation, Rockwell Automation, Inc. cannot assume responsibility or
liability for actual use based on the examples and diagrams.
No patent liability is assumed by Rockwell Automation, Inc. with respect to use of information, circuits, equipment, or
software described in this manual.
Reproduction of the contents of this manual, in whole or in part, without written permission of Rockwell Automation,
Inc., is prohibited
Throughout this manual, when necessary, we use notes to make you aware of safety considerations.
WARNING: Identifies information about practices or circumstances that can cause an explosion in a hazardous
environment, which may lead to personal injury or death, property damage, or economic loss.
ATTENTION: Identifies information about practices or circumstances that can lead to personal injury or death, property
damage, or economic loss. Attentions help you identify a hazard, avoid a hazard, and recognize the consequence.
IMPORTANT Identifies information that is critical for successful application and understanding of the product.
SHOCK HAZARD: Labels may be on or inside the equipment, for example, a drive or motor, to alert people that dangerous
voltage may be present.
BURN HAZARD: Labels may be on or inside the equipment, for example, a drive or motor, to alert people that surfaces may
reach dangerous temperatures.
ARC FLASH HAZARD: Labels may be on or inside the equipment, for example, a motor control center, to alert people to
potential Arc Flash. Arc Flash will cause severe injury or death. Wear proper Personal Protective Equipment (PPE). Follow ALL
Regulatory requirements for safe work practices and for Personal Protective Equipment (PPE).
Table of Contents
Summary of Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Preface
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Additional Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Chapter 1
Overview 857 Relay Protection System Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
SetPointPS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
User Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Setting File and Firmware Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Operating Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
EU Directive Compliance and Other Standard Compliance . . 23
Catalog Number Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Available Replacement Option Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Chapter 2
Local Panel User Interface 857 Protection System Front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Backlight Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Keypad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Menu Navigation and Pointers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Operation Status Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Resetting Latched Indicators and Output Protection
Elements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Adjusting the Display Contrast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Local Panel Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Navigating in Menus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Main Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Menu Structure of Protection Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Fault Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Operating Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
To Gain Access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Password Management. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Restoring a Lost Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Operating Measures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Control Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Measured Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Reading the Event Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Signal Forcing Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Configuration and Parameter Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Parameter Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Chapter 3
Protection Functions Maximum Number of Protection Stages in One Application. . . . . . 67
Protection Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
General Features of Protection Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Start and Trip Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Output Matrix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Blocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Retardation Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Reset Time (Release Time) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Hysteresis or Deadband . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Function Dependencies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Application Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Current Protection Function Dependencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Overcurrent Stage I> (50/51) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Three Independent Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Inverse Operation Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Inverse Time Limitation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Cold Load and Inrush Current Handling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Missing Recorded Value. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Remote Controlled Overcurrent Scaling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Directional Overcurrent Protection Iφ> (67) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Four Independent Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Inverse Operation Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Inverse Time Limitation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Chapter 4
Support Functions Event Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Event Enabling/Masking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Chapter 5
Measurement Functions Measurement Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
UA, UB, UC Voltage Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
RMS Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
RMS Currents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
RMS Voltages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Harmonics and Total Harmonic Distortion (THD) . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Demand Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Minimum and Maximum Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Maximum Values of the Last 31 Days and 12 Months . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Voltage Measurement Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Power Calculations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Line-to-Line Voltages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Line-to-Neutral Voltages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Direction of Power and Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Symmetric Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Primary, Secondary, and Per Unit Scaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Current Scaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Voltage Scaling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Per Unit [pu] Scaling of Line-to-Line Voltages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Chapter 6
Control Functions Output Relays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Digital Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Virtual Inputs and Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Output Matrix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Block Matrix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Controllable Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Object States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Basic Settings for Controllable Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Output Signals of Controllable Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Settings for Read-only Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Controlling with DI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Local/Remote Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Auto-reclose Function (79) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Terminology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Manual Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Manual Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Reclaim Time Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Support for Two Circuit Breakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Blocking of AR Shots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Starting AR Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
The Starting Sequence at Shot 2…5 and Skipping of AR
Shots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Critical AR Request . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Chapter 7
Communications Communication Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Local Port. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Remote Port X9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Extension Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Ethernet Port (Optional). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Communication Protocols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Personal Computer Communication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Modbus TCP and Modbus RTU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Configure the Modbus Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Modbus RTU Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
Modbus TCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Testing Modbus with Simple Tester. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
PROFIBUS DP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
SPA-Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
IEC 60870-5-103. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
DNP 3.0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
IEC 60870-5-101. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
External I/O (Modbus RTU Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
IEC 61850 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
EtherNet/IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
File Transfer Protocol (FTP) Server. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Connect to the FTP Server Using Windows DOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
Using the FTP Client in Windows by Command Line. . . . . . . 287
Using the FTP Client in Windows Through Windows
Explorer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
EtherNet/IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Network Design . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Determine Network Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Set the Network IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Assign Network Parameters with the BOOTP/ DHCP
Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Electronic Data Sheet (EDS) File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
Upload the EDS File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
EDS Add On Profile Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
Predefined Static Ethernet Input and Output Assemblies . . . . . . . . 296
Chapter 8
Applications Substation Feeder Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
Industrial Feeder Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
Parallel Line Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
Ring Network Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
Trip Circuit Supervision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
Internal Parallel Digital Inputs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Trip Circuit Supervision with One Digital Input. . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Non-dry Digital Inputs DI1…DI6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Digital Inputs. . . . . . . . . . . 320
Chapter 9
Connections Rear Panel View. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Details of Terminal Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
Auxiliary Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
Serial Communication Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
Pin Assignments of Communication Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
Front Panel Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
Optional Two-channel Arc Protection Card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
Optional Digital I/O Card (DI19/DI20) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
External Input/Output Modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
Block Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Block Diagrams of Option Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
Optional Arc Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
Connection Examples. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343
Chapter 10
Specifications Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
Tests and Environmental Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
Protection Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
Non-directional Current Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
Directional Current Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357
Frequent Start Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
Voltage Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
Frequency Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
Power Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
Synchrocheck Function ∆f, ∆U, ∆φ (25) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
Circuit-breaker Failure Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363
Magnetizing Inrush If2 > (68F2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363
Transformer Over Excitation If5> (68F5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363
Arc Fault-protection Stages (Option) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
Supporting Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365
Disturbance Recorder (DR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365
Transformer Supervision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366
Voltage Sag and Swell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367
Voltage Interruptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367
Chapter 11
Installation Mounting Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369
Appendix A
Parameter List Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371
Appendix B
Modbus Parameter List Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459
Appendix C
Configuring the 857 Relay in Typical Hardware Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
Studio 5000 Configuring an I/O Profile Using an EDS AOP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472
Select a Static Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472
Download the EDS File from the 857 Relay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473
Register the EDS-based Device into Studio 5000 . . . . . . . . . . . . 474
Configure Device Properties in Studio 5000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
Configuring the 857 I/O Profile Using the Ethernet /IP Bridge . . 479
Set Connection Parameters in RSLogix 5000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479
Configuring the 857 for EtherNet/IP Using the Front Panel . 482
Configuring the 857 for Ethernet/IP Using SetpointPS. . . . . . 484
Configure Produced/Consumed (CIP I/O) Image . . . . . . . . . . 487
Produced and Consuming Assemblies (CIP I/O) Data Table
Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 488
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 491
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503
Topic Page
Added Polarity footnote 233
Added AC Mode information to Digital Inputs section 234
Added Digital Input Threshold Voltages table footnote 235
Updated Output Matrix graphic title 236
Updated Manual Closing section 243
Updated Reclaim Time Settings table 243
Added AR3/AR4, START3/START4, Discr1/Discr2 under Shot Settings 245
Updated Logic Functions section 249
Replaced Communication Ports and Connectors graphic 253
Added I, M, and N rows 255
Updated Ethernet Port section (added text, tables, and images) 257
Added Configuring the Modbus Protocol section 261
Added File Transfer Protocol (FTP) Server section 285
Added Connect to the FTP server using Windows DOS Commands section 287
Replaced Example Connection of Allen-Bradley 857 311
Updated Trip Circuit Supervision section 312
Expanded Trip Circuit Supervision with One Digital Input section 313
Added “Using any of the non-dry digital inputs DI1…DI6” section 317
Added Tip to Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Digital Inputs section 320
Replaced Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Dry Digital Inputs graphic 321
Inserted Trip Supervision with Two Dry Digital Inputs graphic 321
Added three images and content to Trip Circuit Supervision section 322
Inserted Rear Panel Connections of an 857-3C7 graphic 324
Inserted Rear Panel Connections of an 857-3C8 graphic 325
Added Terminal X8 model 857-3C7 table and graphic 329
Added Terminal X8 model 857-3C8 table and graphic 330
Added Terminal X6 with DI19/DI20 option table and graphic 331
Added Optional Built-in Ethernet/61850 Interfaces table and graphic 334
Inserted 857-VCMRTD row 334
Updated Type column in 32 mm-high Modules table 335
Corrected graphic title to 857-VCM485-4 336
Updated External Input/Output Modules and deleted outdated content 338
Replaced Block Diagram of Allen-Bradley 857-3C6 339
Inserted Block Diagram of Allen-Bradley 857-3C7 340
Inserted Block Diagram of Allen-Bradley 857-3C8 341
Inserted Block Diagram of Optional D10/D20 Module with One Arc Channel 342
Updated graphic title to reflect image 343
Updated Measuring Circuitry table and added footnotes 347
Added “(selected by Catalog Number)” 348
Added Start Up Peak section to Auxiliary Voltage table 348
Topic Page
Inserted Ethernet Connection table 350
Updated Operating Temperature in Environmental Conditions table 352
Updated Weight, Dimensions, and IP rating information in Casing table 352
Updated Start time in Overcurrent stage I>(50/51) 353
Updated Start time in Overcurrent stage I>> and I>>>(50/51) 353
Added Delay type, Motor Stop Limit, Motor Running Limit rows 354
Updated all Inverse time characteristic information 354
Added Unbalance Stage I2> (46) table footnote 355
Updated table title to Current unbalance I2> (46) in feeder mode 355
Inserted Pickup Current section 358
Inserted Reset Angle and Updated Inaccuracy section 358
Added Intermittent to table head 358
Added Operating Time 360
Added Low Voltage blocking range 360
Added 2nd Harmonic overcurrent protection stage If2> (68F2) table 360
Added Magnetizing Inrush If2> (68F2) section 363
Added Transformer Over Excitation If5> (68F5) section 363
Added 5th Harmonic stage If5> (68F5) table 364
Added Operating time (delayed Arc L> for Arcl>(50AR) 364
Added Operating time (delayed Arc L> for Arcl01>(50NARC) 364
Added Operating time (delayed Arc L> for Arcl02>(50NARC) 365
Updated Cold Load/Inrush current detection (68) table 365
Added IMAX > and IMIN < settings 366
Added full parameter list to Appendix 371
Added Modbus parameter list to Appendix B 459
Added Appendix C, Connecting to an 857 Protection System with EtherNet/IP in 471
RSLogix 5000®
Notes:
Introduction The Allen-Bradley® 857 motor and feeder protection system includes the
essential protection functions for feeders and motors in distribution networks
of utilities, heavy industry, power plants, and offshore applications. The device
includes many programmable functions, such as arc protection (option),
thermal, trip circuit supervision, and circuit breaker protection and
communication protocols for various protection and communication
situations.
Additional Resources These documents contain additional information concerning related products
from Rockwell Automation®.
Resource Description
SetPointPS Configuration Software Programming Manual, publication Provides information on configuring,
857-PM001 setting up, troubleshooting, and using
the SetPointPS communication
software
857 Protection System for Feeder and Motor Protection Quick Start, Provides information on mounting,
publication 857-QS001 wiring, and installation of the 857 relay
857 Protection System Specification Guide, publication 857-SR001 Provides specifications on protective
features, measuring and monitoring,
arc flash protection, and cold load
pickup monitoring
857-RAA/857-RAD RTD Scanner User Manual, publication 857-UM002 Provides information on layout, wiring,
installation, configurations, mounting
and I/O
857-VPA3CG PROFIBUS DP Option Module, publication 857-UM003 Provides information on the PROFIBUS
option modules, including installation,
commissioning, dimensions, and
specifications
Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, publication Provides general guidelines for
1770-4.1 installing a Rockwell Automation
industrial system.
Product Certifications website, http //www.rockwellautomation.com/ Provides declarations of conformity,
global/certification/overview.page certificates, and other certification
details.
Overview
857 Relay Protection System The major features of the 857 Protection System are shown in the following
list.
Features
• Digital signal is handled with a 16-bit microprocessor, and 16-bit A/D
conversion technique to measure accuracy on all setting ranges.
• Wide setting ranges for the protection functions to a sensitivity of 0.5%.
• Integrated fault location for short circuit faults.
• The Protection System can match the requirements of the application by
disabling unneeded functions.
• Flexible control and digital signal control inputs (DI) and outputs (DO)
for signal blocking.
• Flexible signal-grouping matrix in the device makes it adaptable to
various control and alarm systems.
• Ability to control up to six objects locally (for example circuit-breakers,
disconnectors).
• Status of eight objects (for example circuit breakers, disconnectors,
switches).
• Configurable display with six selectable measurement values.
• Configurable schemes the are interlocking with basic logic functions.
• An event register record of events and fault values that can be read
through the keypad, local HMI, or SetPointPS (a free PC-based
configuration software).
• All settings, events, and indications are stored in nonvolatile memory.
• Configuration, parameterization, and reading of information through
local HMI, or with SetPointPS software interface.
• Connection to any automation system through several available
communication protocols. These protocols include Modbus RTU,
ModbusTCP, PROFIBUS DP, IEC 60870-5-103, IEC 60870-5-101,
IEC 61850, SPA-Bus, EtherNet/IP, or DNP 3.0.
• Universal power supply handles any source within the range from
40…265V DC or V AC. An optional alternative power-supply for
18…36V DC is available.
• Built-in high-resolution disturbance recorder for evaluating analog and
digital signals.
• Arc protection is also provided as an optional feature.
• Two different optional 12-channel RTD scanners available.
SetPointPS
User Interface
• Locally with the push button on the 857 Protection System front panel,
see 857 Protection System Front Panel on page 27).
The Settings files from all major revisions of firmware are not upward or
downward compatible between major versions. This statement is true of
products with firmware revision 10, 12, and higher firmware revisions.
IMPORTANT Do not load a Settings file between 857 Protection Systems of one version
into an 857 Protection System with another firmware revision.
Operating Safety
ATTENTION: The terminals on the rear panel of the 857 Protection System
can carry dangerous voltages, even if the auxiliary voltage is switched off. Do
not place a live current transformer secondary-circuit in an open circuit
condition. The disconnection of a live circuit can cause dangerous voltages!
Any operational measures must be conducted according to national and local
directives and instructions
Power Plants
Distribution
Substation
Remote Control
Interface
Protection
System
i
i i
20 kV Overhead Line
20-kV Cable
Network
Secondary Distribution
Substation Transformer
(Distribution 230/240V
Transformer) 230/240V
a e
Nom Phase Current (A) / Nom DI7-28 Activation Voltage Optional Hardware (Communication port 1)
9 Eight standard inputs and four outputs(1) (1) Required for connection to 857-RAD Enhanced RTD Scanner. Only available in this location.
(2) Required for connection to the 857-RAA scanner only.
(1) Some options not UL Listed. Check with your Rockwell Automation® representative.
f
d Optional Hardware (Communication port 2)
Supply Voltage [V] A None
A 40…265V AC/DC C RJ45 connection (RS-232, 857-VCM232)
B 18…36V DC D RS-485 interface (2-wire, 857-VCM485-2)
C 40…265V AC/DC, arc protection option L Built-in RJ45 10-Mbps Ethernet interface(1)
D 18…36V DC, arc protection option M Built in RJ45 10-Mbps interface inc. IEC 61850(1)
E 40…265V AC/DC, DI19, DI20, arc channel, optional N RTD interface for 857-RAA (Glass fiber, 857-VCMRTD)(2)
F 18…36V DC+ DI19, DI20, arc channel, optional (1) Cannot order in combination with the following optional Communication PORT 1:
(M) ST 100-Mbps EtherNet/IP fiber interface with IEC 61850
(2) Required for connection to the 857-RAA scanner only.
g
Ingress Protection Rating
IP 30 (standard)
I IP 54 with conformal coating (optional)
C IP 30 with conformal coating (optional)
Notes:
857 Protection System Front Figure 2 shows the front panel of the 857 Protection System and the location
of the user interface elements that are used for local control.
Panel
Figure 2 - Front Panel of 857 Protection System
857
Display
The backlit 128 x 64 LCD dot-matrix display can show 21 characters per row
and eight rows simultaneously. The display shows the following:
• The single-line diagram of the 857 Protection System with the object
status, measurement values, identification, and so forth (Figure 3).
• The configuration and parameterization values of the 857 Protection
System (Figure 4).
Backlight Control
To turn on the backlight, press any key on the front HMI of the 857 Protection
System. The Display backlight can also be switched on with any digital input
and virtual input or output by using SetPointPS software. Go to the
“LOCALPANEL CONF/Display backlight ctrl” setting, which is used for
selecting the trigger input for backlight control. When the selected input
activates, the display backlight activated for 60 minutes.
Keypad
The keypad is used to control objects and switches on the single-line diagram
display. To navigate in the menu, and set the required parameter values, use the
keypad and the guidance that is given in the display.
Use the arrow keys up and down to move up and down in the main menu (see
Keypad on page 29). The active main menu option is indicated with a cursor.
The main menu option items are abbreviations, for example Evnt = events.
After any selection, the The name of the active submenu and a
arrow symbols show the possible ANSI code of the selected function.
possible navigating
directions.
The 857 Protection System has eight status indicators (Figure 7) that are listed
in Table 2.
The following are ways to reset latched indicators and protection elements:
• From the alarm list, press and hold the Cancel button for approximately
3 seconds. To reset the latched indicators and output protection
elements press enter.
• To acknowledge each event, press the Enter button the equivalent
number of times. To reset the latched indicators and output protection
elements, press the Enter button in the initial display.
• Reset the latched indicators and output protection elements through a
remote communication or through a digital input that is configured for
that purpose.
The readability of the LCD varies with the brightness and the temperature of
the environment. To adjust the contrast with a personal computer, use the
SetPointPS software GUI. To adjust the contrast from the front of the 857
Protection System complete this procedure.
Local Panel Operations The front panel can be used to control objects, change the local/remote status,
read the measured values, set parameters, and to configure 857 Protection
System functions. A personal computer, which is connected to a local
communication port, can set some parameters.
Navigating in Menus
1. Use the arrow keys (up and down) to move up and down in the main
menu.
2. Move to a submenu by repeatedly pressing the right key until the
required submenu is shown. To return to the main menu, press the left
key.
3. Press enter to confirm the submenu selection.
If there are more than six items in the selected submenu, a black line
appears to the right side of the display (Figure 8). It is then possible to
scroll down in the submenu.
The active main menu selection is indicated with black background color. The
possible navigating directions in the menu are shown in the upper-left corner
with black triangular symbols.
Main Menu
50G/51G
(5)
Io>>> 3 Third earth-fault stage 50N/51N
50G/51G
(5)
Io>>>> 3 Fourth earth-fault stage 50N/51N
50G/51G
(5)
Ioϕ> 6 First directional earth-fault stage 67N
(5)
Ioϕ>> 6 Second directional earth-fault stage 67N
(5)
Ioint> 4 Transient intermittent E/F 67NI
(5)
U> 4 First overvoltage stage 59
(5)
U>> 3 Second overvoltage stage 59
(5)
U>>> 3 Third overvoltage stage 59
(5)
U< 4 First Undervoltage stage 27
(5)
U<< 3 Second Undervoltage stage 27
(5)
U<<< 3 Third Undervoltage stage 27
(5)
Uo> 3 First residual-overvoltage stage 59N
(5)
Uo>> 3 Second residual overvoltage stage 59N
(5)
P< 3 First reverse and underpower stage 32
(5)
P<< 3 Second reverse and underpower stage 32
(5)
f>< 4 First over/under-frequency stage 81
(5)
f>><< 4 Second over/under-frequency stage 81
(5)
f< 4 First underfrequency stage 81L
(5)
f<< 4 Second underfrequency stage 81L
(5)
dfdt 3 Rate of change of frequency (ROCOF) stage 81R
(5)
Prg1 3 First programmable stage
(5)
Prg2 3 Second programmable stage
(5)
Prg3 3 Third programmable stage
(5)
Prg4 3 Fourth programmable stage
(5)
Prg5 3 Fifth programmable stage
(5)
Prg6 3 Sixth programmable stage
(5)
Prg7 3 Seventh programmable stage
(5)
Prg8 3 Eighth programmable stage
(5)
If2> 3 Second harmonic O/C stage 68F2
(5)
If5> 3 Fifth harmonic O/C stage 68F5
(5)
CBFP 3 Circuit breaker failure-protection 50BF
(5)
CBWE 4 Circuit breaker wearing-supervision
AR 15 Auto-reclose 79
(5)
CTSV 1 CT supervisor
VTSV 1 VT supervisor (5)
ArcI> 4 Optional arc protection stage for phase-to-phase faults and 50ARC (5)
delayed light signal.
ArcIo1> 3 Optional arc protection stage for earth-faults. Current input = I01 50NARC (5)
ArcIo2> 3 Optional arc protection stage for earth-faults. Current input = I02 50NARC (5)
The general structure of all protection function menus is similar, but the details
differ from stage to stage. For example, the details of the second overcurrent
stage I>> menus are shown in Figure 10.
The status, start, trip counter, and setting group menu content, as shown in
Figure 10, is explained in the following list:
• Status – The stage is not detecting any fault at the moment. If the
operating level is “Configurator” and the Force flag is set to On, the
stage can be forced to pick up or trip. See Operating Levels on page 40
for more details.
• SCntr 5 – The stage has picked-up a fault five times since the last reset of
restart. This value can be cleared if the operating level is at least Setting
Groups on page 68“Operator”.
• TCntr 1 – The stage has tripped twice since the last reset of restart. This
value can be cleared if the operating level is at least “Operator”.
• SetGrp 1 – The active setting group is one. This value can be edited if
the operating level is at least “Operator”. How to set groups is explained
in Setting Groups on page 68.
• SGrpDI – A digital input does not control this setting group. This value
can be edited if the operating level is at least “Configurator”.
• Force Off – The forcing function for status forcing and output
Protection System forcing are disabled. This force flag status can be set
to “On” or back to “Off ” if the operating level is at least “Configurator”.
If a front panel key is not pressed within 5 minutes, and there is no
SetPointPS communication, the force flag is set to “Off ” position. The
forcing is explained in Signal Forcing Control on page 46.
The content of the main setting menu shown in Figure 11 is explained in the
following list:
• Stage setting group 1 – The group 1 setting values. To view the other
setting group, press enter and then right or left. How to set groups is
explained in Setting Groups on page 68.
• Status – The status of the stage. A copy of the status value in the first
menu.
• I>> 2.50 x In – The pick-up limit is 2.50 times the rated current of the
protected object. This value can be edited if the operating level is at least
“Operator”. The operating levels are explained in Operating Levels on
page 40.
• t>> 0.60s – The total operation delay is set to 600 Ms. This value can be
edited if the operating level is at least “Operator”.
This menu is for registered values by the I>> stage. Fault logs are explained in
Fault Log on page 40.
• FAULT LOG 1 – The latest of the eight available logs. Press enter and
right or left to move between logs.
• Type 1-2 – The overcurrent fault has been detected in phases L1 and L2
(A and B, red and yellow, R and S, u and v).
• Flt 2.86 x In – The fault current has been 2.86 per units.
• Load 0.99 x In – The average load current before the fault has been
0.99 pu.
• EDly 81% – The elapsed operation delay has been 81% of the setting
0.60 s = 0.49 s. Any registered elapsed delay less than 100% means that
the stage has not tripped, because the fault duration has been shorter
than the delay setting.
• SetGrp 1 – The setting group has been 1. To reach this line, press enter
and then down several times.
Setting Groups
Most of the protection functions have four setting groups (SetGrp1, SetGrp2,
SetGrp3, and SetGrp4). These groups are useful, for example, when the
network topology is changed frequently. To change the active group, use a
digital input, through remote communication or locally by using the local
panel.
The active setting group of each protection function can be selected separately.
Figure 13 shows an example where the changing of the I> setting group is
handled with digital input one (SGrpDI). If the digital input is TRUE, the
active setting group is group two. If the digital input is FALSE, the active group
is group one. If no digital input is selected (SGrpDI = -), the active group can
be selected by changing the value of the parameter SetGrp.
Scroll to the desired submenu and press enter to select the submenu. The
selected setting group is in the lower left corner (Figure 14). Set1 is setting
group one, Set2 is setting group two, Set3 is setting group three, and Set4 is
setting group four. Press left or right to select another group. Left is used when
the active setting group is 2 and right is used when the active setting group is 1.
Fault Log
All protection functions include fault logs that can register up to eight
different faults with time stamp information and fault values. The fault logs are
stored in nonvolatile memory, and are not cleared when the power is switched
off. To clear all logs use SetPointPS. Each function has its own logs (see
Figure 15).
To see the values of log two, press enter to select the current log (log one). The
current log number is then indicated in the lower left corner of the display (see
Figure 16, Log2 = log two). Press the right once to select Log two.
Operating Levels
The 857 Protection System has three access levels User, Operator, and
Configurator. The access levels mitigate accidental change of protection system
configurations, parameters, or settings.
USER Level OPERATOR Level CONFIGURATION Level
Use To read parameter values, Control objects and to Needed during the
measurements, and events. change the settings of the commissioning of the Protection
protection stages. System. The scaling of the voltage
and current transformers can be
set by using this level and all
other parameters can be
changed.
Password No; levels permanently Yes; default configuration Yes; default configuration
Protected? open. password is 0001. password is 0002.
Setting State Press enter Press enter
Logout Closing that is not required. Automatically closes after Automatically closes after 10-
10-minutes idle time. To minutes idle time. To close enter
close enter password 9999. password 9999.
To Gain Access
Password Management
Command Description
get pwd_break Get the break code (Example: 6569403)
get serno Get the serial number of the 857 Protection System
(Example: 12345)
Send both the numbers to Rockwell Automation and ask for a password break.
A device-specific break code is sent back. The code is valid for two weeks for
the specific device.
Command Description
set pwd_break=4435876 Restore the default configuration passwords (“4435876”
is just an example; the actual code must be requested
from the Rockwell Automation support team.
Now the passwords are restored to the default values (see Operating Levels on
page 40).
The operator password must be active to control the objects, see To Gain
Access on page 41.
Object Control
Measured Data
The measured values can be read from the main menus and their submenus.
Any measurement value in this table can be displayed on the main view next to
the single-line diagram. Up to six selectable measurements can be shown on the
default main display and 30 more on addition measurement screens.
Table 4 - Measured Values
Value Menu/Submenu Description
P P/POWER Active power [kW]
Q P/POWER Reactive power [kVAR]
S P/POWER Apparent power [kVA]
? P/POWER Active power angle [?]
P.F. P/POWER Power factor [ ]
f P/POWER Frequency [Hz]
Pda P/15 MIN POWER Active power [kW]
Qda P/15 MIN POWER Reactive power [kVAR]
Sda P/15 MIN POWER Apparent power [kVA]
Pfda P/15 MIN POWER Power factor [ ]
fda P/15 MIN POWER Frequency [Hz]
PL1 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Active power of phase 1 [kW]
PL2 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Active power of phase 2 [kW]
PL3 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Active power of phase 3 [kW]
QL1 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Reactive power of phase 1 [kVAR]
QL2 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Reactive power of phase 2 [kVAR]
QL3 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Reactive power of phase 3 [kVAR]
SL1 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Apparent power of phase 1 [kVA]
SL2 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Apparent power of phase 2 [kVA]
SL3 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Apparent power of phase 3 [kVA]
PF_L1 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Power factor of phase 1 [ ]
PF_L2 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Power factor of phase 2 [ ]
PF_L3 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Power factor of phase 3 [ ]
cos P/COS and TAN Cosine phi [ ]
tan P/COS and TAN Tangent phi [ ]
cosL1 P/COS and TAN Cosine phi of phase L1 [ ]
cosL2 P/COS and TAN Cosine phi of phase L2 [ ]
cosL3 P/COS and TAN Cosine phi of phase L3 [ ]
Iseq P/PHASE SEQUENCIES Actual, current phase sequence [OK; Reverse;?? ]
Useq P/PHASE SEQUENCIES Actual, voltage phase sequence [OK; Reverse;?? ]
Io1ϕ P/PHASE SEQUENCIES I/O/Uo angle [o]
Io2ϕ P/PHASE SEQUENCIES I/O2/Uo angle [o]
fAdop P/PHASE SEQUENCIES Adopted frequency [Hz]
E+ E/ENERGY Exported energy [MWh]
The event register can be read from the Event submenu by using the following
steps.
To set the order in which the events are sorted, set the “Order” parameter to
“New-Old”. In the EVENT LIST, the first event is the most recent event.
4. Press enter.
5. Press up or down to change from “OFF” to “ON”, to activate the Force
function.
6. Press enter to return to the selection list. Choose the signal that Force
controls with the up and down keys, for instance the T1 signal.
7. Press enter to confirm the selection. Force now controls Signal T1.
8. Press up or down to change the selection from “0” (not alert) to “1”
(alert) or vice versa.
9. Press enter to execute the forced control operation of the selected
function. For example, when making the output Protection System of
T1 pickup.
10. Repeat steps 7 and 8 to alternate between the on and off state of the
function.
11. Repeat steps 1…4 to exit the Force function.
12. Return to the main menu by pressing cancel.
ATTENTION: All interlockings and blockings are bypassed when the force
control is used. Use ONLY in an off-line test condition.
Some of the parameters can only be changed through the RS-232 serial port
with the SetPointPS software. These parameters (for example passwords,
blockings, and mimic configuration) are normally set only during the
commission process.
Some of the parameters require the restarting of the Protection System, which
is automatic. If a parameter change requires the restarting, of the Protection
System the display shows as Figure 19. A similar warning is displayed when
using SetPointPS.
WARNING: Do not cycle control power to the 857 Protection System; the
Protection System automatically restarts.
Parameter Setting
1. Press enter to move to the setting state of the desired menu (for example,
CONF/CURRENT SCALING). The Pick text appears in the upper-
left part of the display.
2. Press info. Enter the password that is associated with the configuration
level by pressing the arrow keys (default value is 0002). Press enter.
For more information about the access levels, see Operating Levels on
page 40.
3. Press up and down to scroll through the parameters. A parameter can be
set when the background color of the line is black. If the parameter
cannot be set, the parameter is framed.
If the given parameter setting values are out-of-range values, a fault message is
shown when the setting is confirmed with the enter key. Adjust the setting so it
is within the allowed range.
The allowed setting range is shown in the display in the setting mode. To view
the range, press info. To return to the setting mode press CANCEL.
Through the sub menus of the disturbance recorder menu, these functions and
features can be read and set.
1. Disturbance Settings
2. Manual trigger (ManTrg)
3. Status (Status)
4. Clear oldest record (Clear)
5. Clear all records (ClrAll)
6. Recording completion (Stored)
7. Count of ready records (ReadyRec)
These functions can be read and set through the submenus of the digital inputs
menu.
• The status of digital inputs (DIGITAL INPUTS 1-20/24/32).
• Operation counters (DI COUNTERS).
• Operation delay (DELAYs for DigIn).
• The polarity of the input signal (INPUT POLARITY). Normally open
(NO) or normally closed (NC) circuit.
• To enable Event, EVENT MASK1.
These functions can be read and set through the submenus of the digital
outputs menu.
• The status of the output protection systems relays (RELAY OUTPUTS
1, 2, 3, and 4).
• The forcing of the output protection systems relays (RELAY
OUTPUTS 1, 2, 3, and 4) (only if Force = ON):
– Forced control (0 or 1) of the Trip relays.
– Forced control (0 or 1) of the Alarm relays.
– Forced control (0 or 1) of the S relay.
• The configuration of the output signals to the output relays. The
configuration of the status indicators Alarm and Trip and application-
specific alarm status indicators A, B, and C (the output relay matrix).
TIP The quantity of Trip and Alarm relays depends on the Protection System
type and optional hardware.
These functions can be read and set through the submenus of the Prot menu.
• Reset all counters (PROTECTION SET/ClAll).
• Read the status of all protection functions (PROTECT STATUS 1-x).
• Enable and disable protection functions (ENABLED STAGES 1-x).
• Define the interlockings between signals (only with SetPointPS).
The Configuration Menu contains functions and features that can be read and
set through the submenus of the configuration menu, from the front of the 857
Protection System.
Device Setup
• Set the bit rate for the command-line interface in ports X4 and the front
panel. The front panel uses this setting. If SPA-Bus is selected for the
rear-panel local port X4, the bit rate is according to SPA-Bus settings.
• Displays the access level [Acc]
• Personal computer access level [PCAcc]
Language
Current Scaling
• Rated phase CT primary current (Inom).
• Rated phase CT secondary current (Isec).
• Rated input of the relay [Iinput]. 5 A or 1 A, as specified in the order
code of the device.
• Rated value of I01 CT primary current (Ionom).
• Rated value of I01 CT secondary current (Iosec).
• Rated I01 input of the Protection System [Ioinp]. 5 A or 1 A, as specified
in the order code of the device.
• Rated value of I02 CT primary current (Io2nom).
• Rated value of I02 CT secondary current (Io2sec).
• Rated I02 input of the Protection System [Io2inp]. 5A, 1 A or 0.2, as
specified in the order code of the device.
The rated input values are equal to the rated secondary value of the CT.
The rated CT secondary can be greater than the rated input, but the
continuous current must be less than four times the rated input. In
compensated, high impedance that is earthed, and isolated networks with a
cable transformer to measure residual current I0, a relay used. The relay has 1 A
or 0.2 A input, and the CT is 5 A or 1 A, which increases the measurement
accuracy.
The rated CT secondary can also be less than the rated input, but the
measurement accuracy near zero current decreases.
Motor Currents
Voltage Scaling
• Rated VT primary voltage (Uprim).
• Rated VT secondary voltage (Usec).
• Rated U0 VT secondary voltage (Uosec).
• Voltage measuring-mode (Umode).
Frequency Adaption
• Mode (Auto, Fixed, Manual).
• Adapted Frequency (fAdop).
Fundemantal/RMS
• Energy (Fundamental, RMS).
• Display Fundamental (On/Off ).
• Display RMS (On/Off ).
Device info
• Protection System type (857).
• Serial number (SerN).
• Software version (PrgVer).
• Bootcode version (BootVer).
Date/Time Setup
• Day, month, and year (Date).
• Time of day (Time).
• Date format (yyyy-mm-dd, dd.mm.yyyy, or mm/dd/yyyy).
Clock Synchronization
• Digital input for minute sync pulse (SyncDI). If any digital input is not
used for synchronization, select “-”.
• Daylight Savings Time for NTP synchronization (DST).
• Detected source of synchronization (SyScr).
• Synchronization message counter (MsgCnt).
• Latest synchronization deviation (Dev).
These parameters are visible only when the access level is higher than “User”.
• Offset, that is constant error, of the synchronization source (SyOS).
• Auto adjust interval (AAIntv).
• Average drift direction (AvDrft): “Lead” or “lag”.
• Average synchronization deviation (FilDev).
Software Options
• Application Mode (Feeder, Motor).
• Dist. Earth-fault (On/Off ).
• MIMIC (On/Off ).
Remote Port
• Communication protocol for remote port X5 [Protocol].
• Message counter [Msg#]. Can be used to verify that the device is
receiving messages.
• Communication error counter [Errors].
• Communication time-out error counter [Tout].
• Information of bit rate/data bits/parity/stop bits.
This value is not directly editable. An edit is done in the protocol setting
menus. The counters are useful when testing the communication.
Local Port
This port is disabled if the 857-VX003-3 cable is connected to the front panel
connector.
• Communication protocol for the local port X4 [Protocol]. For
SetPointPS use “None”.
• Message counter [Msg#]. Can be used to verify that the device is
receiving messages.
• Communication error counter [Errors].
• Communication time-out error counter [Tout].
• Information of bit rate/data bits/parity/stop bits.
This value is not directly editable. An edit is done in the protocol setting
menus. For SetPointPS and protocol “None”, the setting is done in
Protection System menu CONF/DEVICE SETup.
Extension Port(1)
• Communication protocol for extension port X4 [Protocol]. For
connection to the 857-RAD enhanced RTD scanner, select External
I/O. See publication 857-UM002 for complete details.
• Message counter [Msg#]. Used to verify that the device is receiving
messages.
• Communication error counter [Errors].
• Communication time-out error counter [Tout].
• Information of bit rate/data bits/parity/stop bits.
• This value is not directly editable. An edit is done in the protocol setting
menus.
Ethernet Port
These parameters are used by the Ethernet interface. For changing the
nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn Ethernet port settings, SetPointPS is recommended.
• Ethernet port protocol [Protoc].
• IP Port for protocol [Port].
• IP address [IpAddr].
• Net mask [NetMsk].
• Gateway [Gatew].
• Name server [NameSw].
• Network time protocol (NTP) server [NTPSvr].
• IP Port for SetPointPS [VS Port].
• TCP Keep alive interval [KeepAlive]
• Media access control address [MAC]
• Message counter [Msg#].
• Error counter [Errors].
• Timeout counter [Tout].
Modbus
• TCP Keep alive interval [Keepalive].
• Modbus address for this slave device [Addr]. This address must be
unique within the system.
• Modbus bit rate [bit/s]. Default is “9600”.
• Parity [Parity]. Default is “Even”.
SPA-Bus
IEC 60870-5-103
PROFIBUS
DNP 3.0
IEC 60870-5-101
• Bit rate [bit/s]. Default is “9600”.
• [Parity].
• Link layer address for this device [LLAddr].
• ASDU address [ALAddr].
SetPointPS Personal SetPointPS is a free personal computer program available for configuration and
setting of Allen-Bradley® 857 and 865 protection systems. Obtain the latest
Computer Software SetPointPS software from www.ab.com. See 857-PM001 for more
information.
The personal computer user-interface can be used for the following tasks:
• Do the on-site parameter settings of the protection system.
• Load protection system software from a computer.
• Read measured values, registered values, and events to a computer.
• Do a continuous monitoring of all values and events.
• Inject digital voltage and current signals for protection validation and
troubleshooting.
Two RS-232 serial ports can be available for connecting a local personal
computer with SetPointPS to the protection system. One on the front panel
(standard) and one on the rear panel of the protection system (optional).
These two serial ports are connected in parallel. If the connection cables are
connected to both ports, only the port on the front panel is active. To connect
a personal computer to a serial port, use a connection cable Bulletin 857-
VX003-3.
The SetPointPS program can also use an Ethernet TCP/IP LAN connection.
An optional Ethernet communication-port is required.
The single-line diagram is drawn with the SetPointPS software. For more
information, see the SetPointPS manual, publication 857-PM001.
Webset Through Hypertext The Webset HTTP configuration interface can configure the device with a
web browser (Explorer, Mozilla Firefox, or Google Chrome). The feature is
Transfer Protocol (HTTP) available on 857 protection systems that are equipped with a built-in or
Server optional Ethernet card and firmware revision 12.001 or newer installed.
Webset provides a subset of features that are provided by SetPointPS, the
configuration software. The same group lists and group views are available
except for the LOGIC and the MIMIC groups, which are configurable only
through SetPointPS.
For web access to the 857 protection system, configure the protection system
to enable HTTP services.
The HTTP server can be enabled(1) within the 857 protection system by using
these methods:
(1) Configurator access level is required to enable the HTTP server. The 857 Protection System requires a restart before this feature is
enabled.
Figure 26 - Main Page and the Functional Areas of the Configurator Mode on a Bulletin 857
There are several interactive controls that are included with the Webset
configurator. See Figure 26 for the functional areas within the Webset
interface.
Fields that are styled with a light green color and bold font are editable. The
exception is that matrices are shown in this style.
Caption View
The Caption View in Webset features a row of menu buttons (see Figure 26).
The basic interaction and use of these buttons is as follows(1):
• Auto-Refresh: a toggle-button for enabling/disabling automatic
periodic content refresh from a menu item from the 857 Protection
System. The button changes to a dark green when enabled. If another
menu selection is made, the Auto Refresh is automatically disengaged.
The refresh interval depends on the size of the current page being
displayed. Its use is recommended mostly for monitoring the metering
values, such as those in the MEASUREMENTS group.
• Refresh Menu: refreshes the current Group View one time.
• Refresh Content: refreshes the Group View menu-item contents, one
time.
• Restart Device: issues a restart command to the 857 Protection System,
after clicking OK in the popup prompt. The Cancel command can be
used from this popup prompt.(2)
• Log out: logs the user out of the web-based session.
Menu/Group List
The menu/group list functionality mimics the functions available by using
SetPointPS programming software (see publication 857-PM001). The list is
generated based on the options that are available in the device connected. To
scroll down the list, use the slider bar on the right side of this portion of the
control window.
Content/Group View
To edit the settings, click the element name in the Content/Group View area.
See Figure 27.
(1) The web interface is an online real-time interaction service. Any changes that are made are sent to the Protection System
immediately. Some pages could take up to 10 seconds to load in some browsers version. Subsecond response is typical.
(2) Configurator access level is required. The 857 Protection System key restarts once the command is initiated which could result in
a change of state of all output 857 Protection Systems.
If a change is made to a given parameter, which affects other values on the page,
these other values do not automatically update. Refresh the content or enable
the Auto-refresh function. This aspect depends on type of change being made.
Updating the page with the browser refresh function is also an option, but can
provide a slower response time than the Webset refresh functionality.
For some parameter changes, the editing of a value requires the 857 Protection
System to restart. In this case, the edited field will turn yellow after the submit
button has been clicked to indicate that a restart is required. The Protection
System protective mode has been changed to Feeder Protection Mode from
Motor Protection Mode. The yellow color (Figure 29) signifies that a restart of
the Protection System is required to initialize this change.
Notes:
Protection Functions
Maximum Number of The device limits the maximum number of enabled stages to about 30,
depending on the type of the stages. For more information, see Configuration
Protection Stages in One and Parameter Setting on page 47.
Application
IMPORTANT Since the 857 relay is designed to be applied in any global location, the term
‘Start’ is used universally throughout the product to indicate that protective
element or condition is in an alarm state or condition. This term is used
throughout the product and this document.
The status of a protective stage can show Blocked. The block can be due to an
active signal through the block matrix from other stages, the programmable
logic, or any digital input. Some stages also have built-in logic for blocking. For
example, an under frequency stage is blocked if the voltage is too low. For more
details about block matrix, see Measurement Functions on page 215.
The “Force flag” parameter forces the status of any protection stage to be
“start” or “trip” for a half second. By using the parameter, no current or voltage
injection to the Protection System is required check the following:
• The output matrix configuration.
• The wiring from the output relays to the circuit breaker or contactor.
• The communication protocols are correctly transferring event
information to a remote system.
After testing, the force flag automatically resets 5 minutes after the last local
panel push button activity.
The force flag also enables the forcing of the output relays and the forcing of
the optional mA outputs. Force Flag is found in the Relays menu.
Every protection stage has two internal binary-output signals, start and trip.
The start signal is issued when a fault is detected (Alarm condition). The trip
signal is issued after the configured operation delay, unless the fault disappears
before the end of the delay time. These conditions can be configured to Trip or
Alarm relays or virtual outputs.
Output Matrix
The output matrix is used to connect the internal start and trip signals to the
output relays and indicators, see Control Functions on page 233.
Blocking
Any protection function, except arc protection, can be blocked with internal
and external signals when the block matrix is used. See Measurement Functions
on page 215). For example, internal signals are logic outputs and start and trip
signals from other stages and external signals are digital and virtual inputs.
Some protection stages have the blocking functions built-in. For example,
under-frequency protection has the blocking for undervoltage built-in to avoid
tripping when the voltage is off.
Retardation Time
tFAULT
tRET ≤ 50 ms
TRIP CONTACTS
For example, when there is a large fault in an outgoing feeder, it can start (that
is pick-up both the incoming and outgoing feeder Protection System). Clear
the fault by the outgoing feeder relay. The incoming feeder relay must not trip.
Set the operating delay of the incoming feeder so that it is greater than at the
outgoing feeder. The incoming feeder can still trip if the operation time
difference is inadequate. The difference must be more than the retardation
time of the incoming feeder relay, plus the operating time of the outgoing
feeder circuit breaker.
Figure 31 shows an overcurrent fault as seen by the incoming feeder, when the
outgoing feeder does clear the fault. An unselective trip can happen (the
dashed 40-ms pulse in the figure) if either the following occurs:
• The operation delay setting is slightly shorter.
• The fault duration is slightly longer than in the figure.
Figure 32 shows an example of reset time (release delay) when the Protection
System is clearing an overcurrent fault. When the protection system trip
contacts are closed, the circuit breaker (CB) starts to open. After the CB
contacts are open, the fault current still flows through an arc between the
opened contacts. The current is finally cut when the arc extinguishes at the
next zero -crossing of the current (the start moment of the reset delay). After
the reset delay, the trip contacts and start contact are opened unless the latching
is configured. The reset time varies from fault to fault depending on the fault
size. After a significant fault, the time is longer. The reset time also depends on
the specific protection stage. The maximum reset time for each stage is
specified in Chapter 10. For most stages, it is less than 95 ms.
tSET
tCB
tRESET
TRIP CONTACTS
Hysteresis or Deadband
Hysteresis
PICK up LEVEL
>PICK up
PICK up LEVEL
>PICK up
There are two application modes available within the protection system the
feeder protective mode and the motor protective mode. In feeder protective
mode, all current-dependent protection functions are relative to nominal
current In derived by CT ratios. The motor protection functions are
unavailable in the feeder protective mode. In the motor protective mode, all
current-dependent protection functions are relative to the nominal current
Imot of the motor. The motor protective mode enables motor protection
functions. All functions that are available in the feeder protective mode are also
available in the motor protective mode.
The application mode can be changed with the SetPointPS software or from
CONF menu in the device. To change the application mode, it requires the
configurator password, and a restart of the protection system.
I2> (46), I2>> (47), Ist> (48), and N> (66) are dependent on IMOT and are
only available when the application mode is motor protection.
Overcurrent Stage I> (50/51) Overcurrent protection is used against short circuit faults and heavy overloads.
IMPORTANT When the 857 is used for control and protection of fuse and contactor based
configuration (E2), 50/51 protection elements should only be used for
alternative functions or used to block the tripping of the switching device for
currents greater than the switching device's interrupting rating.
There are three adjustable overcurrent stages I>, I>>, and I>>>. The first stage
I> can be configured for definite time (DT) or inverse time operation
characteristic (IDMT). The stages I>> and I>>> have DT operation
characteristic. By using the definite delay type and setting the delay to its
minimum, an instantaneous (ANSI 50) operation is obtained.
Figure 35 shows a functional block diagram of the I> overcurrent stage with
DT and inverse time operation time. Figure 36 shows a functional block
diagram of the I>> and I>>> overcurrent stages with DT operation delay.
The maximum measured secondary current is 50 x IN, which limits the scope
of inverse curves with high pick-up settings. See Inverse Time Operation on
page 157.
Setting Groups
There are four settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs,
virtual inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to
switch between setting groups.
Figure 35 - Block Diagram of the Three-phase Overcurrent Stage I> and I’>
Im1
Im2 Max Start
Im3 ts tr
Register
Block Event
Trip
Register
Event
Figure 36 - Block Diagram of the Three-phase Overcurrent Stage I>> and I>>>
Im1
Im2 Start
Max
Im3 ts tr
Register
Block Event
Trip
Register
Event
Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp, fault
type, fault current, load current before the fault, elapsed delay, and setting
group.
Table 9 - Recorded Values of Overcurrent Stages (Eight Latest Faults) I>, I>>, I>>> (50/51)
Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh : mm: ss: ms Time stamp, time of day
Type Fault type:
1-N Ground fault
2-N Ground fault
3-N Ground fault
1-2 Two-phase fault
2-3 Two-phase fault
3-1 Two-phase fault
1,2,3 Three-phase fault
Flt xImode Maximum fault current
Load xImode 1-s average phase currents before the fault
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
SetGrp 1 …4 Active setting group during fault
Pick-up setting of the three overcurrent stages can also be controlled remotely.
In this case, only two coefficients for scaling are possible100% (the scaling is
inactive) and any configured value between 10…200% (the scaling is active).
When scaling is enabled, all settings of group one are copied to group two. But
the pick-up value of group two is changed, according to the given value
(10…200%).
• This feature is enabled/disabled through SetPointPS or by using the
local panel. When using SetPointPS, the scaling can be activated and
adjusted in the “protection stage status 2” –menu. The local panel has
similar settings that are found in the “prot” -menu.
• It is also possible to change the scaling factor remotely by using the
Modbus TCP –protocol. When changing the scaling factor remotely,
the value of 1% is equal to 1. Check the correct Modbus address for this
application from the SetPointPS or from the communication parameter
list.
Figure 37 shows the effect of remote scaling. After enabling, group is changed
from group one to group two and all settings from group one are copied to
group two. The difference is that group two uses scaled pick-up settings.
IMPORTANT When the remote scaling function is used, all settings of group 2, 3, and 4
are placed. This function cannot be used simultaneously with normal group
changes.
Directional Overcurrent The directional overcurrent protection can be used for directional short circuit
protection. Typical applications are the following:
Protection Iφ> (67)
• Short circuit protection of two parallel cables or overhead lines in a
radial network.
The stages are sensitive to the amplitude of the highest fundamental frequency
current of the three measured phase currents. The phase angle is based on the
phase angle of the three-phase power phasor. For details of power direction, see
Direction of Power and Current on page 222. A typical characteristic is shown
in Figure 38. The base angle setting is –30°. The stage picks up, if the tip of the
three-phase current phasor gets into the gray area.
Set Value
-res. 0° +res.
ILOAD
Trip Area
-Capacitive +Inductive
-90°
Directional+back-up mode works the same way as directional mode but it has
undirectional back-up protection in case a close-up fault forces all voltages to
about zero. After the angle memory hold time, the direction would be lost.
Basically the directional+backup mode is required when operation time is set
longer than voltage memory setting and no other undirectional back-up
protection is in use.
-Capacitive +Inductive.
-90°
The stage picks up and issues a start signal when any of the three phase
currents:
• Exceeds the setting value.
• Is in directional mode and has a phase angle including the base angle
within the active ± 88° wide sector.
If this fault situation remains on longer than the delay setting, a trip signal is
issued.
There are four separately adjustable stages available: Iφ>, Iφ>>, Iφ>>>, and
Iφ>>>>.
See Cold Load Pick-up and Inrush Current Detection on page 180.
Setting Groups
There are four settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs,
virtual inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to
switch between setting groups. For details on setting ranges, seeProtection
Stages on page 353.
Im1
Im2 Start
Max ts tr
Im3 Register
Block Event
IL1 Trip
IL3 P
U12 Phase
U23 Angle Register
Event
Table 10 - Parameters of the Directional Overcurrent Stages Iφ>, Iφ>> (67) (Continued)
Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp, fault
type, fault current, load current before the fault, which is elapsed delay, and
setting group.
Current Unbalance Stage I2> The unbalance stage detects unbalanced load conditions. For example, a
broken conductor or a heavy loaded overhead line if there is no earth-fault.
(46) in Feeder Protection
Mode The operation of the unbalanced load function is based on the negative-phase-
sequence component I2 related to the positive-phase sequence component I1.
This function is calculated from the phase currents with the method of
symmetrical components. The function requires that the measuring inputs are
connected correctly so that the rotation directions of the phase currents are as
in Chapter 9. The unbalance protection has DT operation characteristic.
I
K2 = ---2- , where
I1
3
a = 1 ∠120° = – 1--- + j ------- , a phasor rotating constant.
2 2
Current Unbalance Current unbalance in a motor causes double frequency currents in the rotor.
This unbalance warms up the surface of the rotor. The available thermal
Protection I2> (46) in Motor capacity of the rotor is much less than the thermal capacity of the whole motor.
Protection Mode An rms only current based overload protection (see Thermal Overload
Protection T> (49) on page 124) cannot prevent a motor from a current
unbalance.
The current unbalance protection is based on the negative sequence of the base
frequency phase-currents. Both definite and inverse time characteristics are
available. Incorrect current phase sequencing to the 857 can result in abnormal
and extreme unbalanced values.
Inverse Delay
Equation 3.1
K1 -
T = --------------------------
2 , where
--------
I 2 -
– K2
2
I MOT
If multiple DT delay stages are needed for current unbalance protection, the
freely programmable stages (99) can be used (see Programmable Stages (99) on
page 151).
Setting Groups
There are four settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs,
virtual inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to
switch between setting groups.
500 K 2= 2 % K 2= 40 % K 2= 70 %
200
50
K 2= 2 % K 2= 40 % K 2= 70 %
20
10
5
K 1= 1 s
2
1
0 20 40 60 80 100
Negative Sequence current2 I (%)
Incorrect Phase Sequence The phase sequence stage helps prevent the motor from running in the wrong
direction. When the ratio between negative and positive sequence current
Protection I2>> (47) exceeds 80%, the phase sequence stage starts and trips after 100 ms. Visual
indication of correct voltage and current phase sequencing is provided through
the relay measurement functions.
Table 17 - Parameters of the Incorrect Phase Sequence Stage: I2>> (47)
Stall Protection Ist> (48) The stall protection (unit Ist>) measures the fundamental frequency
component of the phase currents.
Protection (stage Ist>) can be configured for definite time or inverse time
operation characteristic.
The stall protection stage helps protect the motor against prolonged full voltage
starts caused by a stalled rotor. The pickup setting Ist> is the current detection
level for a motor start, too high of load inertia, or too low of system voltage. This
protection stage is sensitive to the fundamental frequency component of the
phase currents. The Ist> stage can be configured for definite operation time or
inverse-time operation characteristics. For a weak power system voltage, the
inverse characteristic is useful. This characteristic allows more start time when the
voltage drop decreases the starting current, and increases the starting time.
Figure 43 shows an example of the inverse characteristics.
If the measured current is less than the specified start current (ISTART ), the
operation time is longer than the specified start time (TSTART ) and vice versa.
While the current has been under 10% of IMOT, and IStart is exceeded by
200 milliseconds. The stall protection stage starts to count the operation time
TSTART according to Equation 3.2 . The equation is also drawn in Figure 43.
When current drops below 120% x IMOT, the stall protection stage releases. Stall
protection is active only during the start of the motor.
Equation 3.2
T = ----------
I START 2
- T , where
I MEAS START
TIME
TSTART
If the measured current is less than the specified start current ISTART, the
operation time is longer than the specified start time TSTART and vice versa.
Register
& Event
Figure 45 - Motor Status in SetPointPS Displayed on the Local Panel of the Protection System
The status of the motor can be viewed through the SetPointPS software or by
the MSTAT status display on the Protection System. These motor status
conditions are also found in the Output and Block Matrix. These status signals
can be used for tripping, indication, or for purpose of protection blocking.
Soft Starting
Frequency converter drives and voltage-based soft starters do not initiate the
Motor Starting status due to the lower currents during the starting of the
motor. The motor status changes directly from the Motor Stopped to Motor
Running position when the current increases to a certain level.
RUN
The default value for Start Detection is a value of six times the motor Nom
current (6 x IMOT ).
The problem with various soft starting methods is the impact to the traditional
full voltage motor starting current profile. This will generally cause the 857 not
to engage the Motor Starting status indication.
As well, the protection settings tend to be done related to a full voltage start
and a normal running level of protection. Thus, an alternative signal is required
to accomplish the blocking during starting.
In most cases, the soft starters and adjustable speed drives are already providing
good levels of start protection that is based on specific protection algorithms in
their control firmware. In most of these types of applications, the 857 is
providing a level of redundant start protection. However, the 857 can
accommodate these types of applications in several different ways. Many of the
857 protection elements can be adjusted to have multiple programmed
protective conditions if the customer so desires. The user can select from
Group 1 (default) through Group 4 setting by using any one of the digital
inputs as a switching command.
The most effective method is to use one or more control signals to Block select
protection elements during a given condition or state. In this case, a reduce
voltage or variable frequency start.
Frequent Start Protection The most common way to start an asynchronous motor is to switch the stator
windings to the supply voltages. Each start heats up the motor considerably
N> (66) because the initial currents are higher than the rated current.
When the motor current has been less than 10% of IMOT and then exceeds
IST>, the situation is recognized as a Start. When the current is less than
10% x IMOT, the motor is regarded as stopped. See Motor Status on page 91
for additional details.
This stage produces a signal when the second last start has been completed. A
trip signal is normally activated and released when there are no starts left.
Figure 49 shows an application.
Figure 49 - Application to Prevent Frequent Starts, Using N> Stage - Breaker Control
The A1 relay has been configured to + +
Normally Closed (NC) and controlled by − −
STOP START
the N> motor start inhibit signal. Open Close
Whenever N> motor start becomes Coil Coil
activated, it stops the circuit breaker from
closing.
M
+
I> start
I> trip
N>alarm
N> motor start inhibit
The Frequent Start Protection must be adapted for use with electrically held
breakers or contactors. This adaption is due to the initiation or trigger point
that is used within the firmware. See Figure 50.
Figure 50 - Application to Prevent Frequent Starts, Using the N> Stage - Contactor Control
857 857
T1 STOP START
A1
CR
CR
The A1 contact, which is shown in Figure 50, is used to block subsequent starts
after the last programmed available start. The A1 contact is mapped to the
“N>motor start inhibition” status signal in the output matrix.
Undercurrent Protection The undercurrent unit measures the fundamental frequency component of the
phase currents.
I< (37)
The stage I< can be configured for DT characteristic.
The undercurrent stage helps protect the motor driven device, for example a
submersible pump, rather than the motor itself.
Directional Earth-fault The directional earth-fault-protection is used for earth-faults. This protection
is used in networks or motors where a selective and sensitive earth-fault-
Protection I0φ> (67N) protection is needed in applications with network structures and lengths that
vary.
Polarization
The negative zero sequence voltage –U0 is used for polarization, which is the
angle reference for I0. The–U0 voltage can be measured in two ways, by the
energizing input U0 or calculated from the phase voltages internally. The
measurement mode depends on the selected voltage measurement mode (see
Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219):
• LN: the zero sequence voltage is calculated from the phase voltages so
separate zero sequence voltage transformers are not needed. The setting
values are relative to the configured voltage transformer (VT) voltage/
√3.
TIP The U0 signal (X1-17 and X1-18) must be connected according to the
connection diagram (Figure 186 on page 343) to get a correct polarization.
The negative U0, –U0, is connected to the device.
• Sector
This mode is used with networks that are earthed with a small/low
resistance. In this context “small” means that the earth-fault current can
be more than the rated phase currents. The trip area has a shape of a
sector as shown in Figure 53. The base angle is set to zero degrees or
slightly on the lagging inductive side (that is negative angle).
• Undir
This mode makes the stage equal to the undirectional stage I0>. The
phase angle and U0 amplitude setting are discarded. Only the amplitude
of the selected I0 input is supervised.
Each stage can be connected to supervise any of these inputs and signals:
• Input I01 for all networks other than rigidly earthed.
• Input I02 for all networks other than rigidly earthed.
• Calculated signal I0Calc for rigidly and low impedance earthed
networks. I0Calc = IL1 + IL2 + IL3 = 3I0.
Intermittent earth-faults make the protection to “start” (to pick up), but does
not cause a trip. Here an intermittent fault means one cycle or more. For
shorter than 1-ms transient type of intermittent earth-faults in compensated
networks, there is a dedicated stage I0int> 67NI. When starting happens with
enough frequency, such intermittent faults can be cleared using the
intermittent time setting. When a new “start” happens within the set
intermittent time, the operation delay counter is not cleared between adjacent
faults and finally the stage trips.
There are two separately adjustable stages: Iφ> and Iφ>>. Both the stages can be
configured for definite time (DT) delay or inverse time delay operation.
Inverse delay means that the operation time depends on the amount the
measured current exceeds the pick-up setting. The bigger the fault current is
the faster the operation. Accomplished inverse delays are available for both
stages I0φ> and I0φ>>. The inverse delay types are described in Inverse Time
Operation on page 157. The device shows a scalable graph of the configured
delay on the local panel display.
Setting Groups
There are two settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs, virtual
inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch
between setting groups.
Figure 51 - Block Diagram of the Directional Earth-fault Stages I0φ> and I0φ>>
Io Isinφ
Start
Icosφ
Register
Block Event
Uo Trip
t
Register
Event
TIP The drawn I0 phasor in both figures is inside the trip area.
The angle offset and half sector size are parameters that are user-defined.
Table 21 - Parameters of the Directional Earth-fault Stages I0φ>, I0φ>> (67N) (Continued)
There is detailed information available of the eight latest faults: Time stamp,
fault type, fault current, load current before the fault, elapsed delay, and setting
group.
Earth-fault Phase Detection A faulty phase is initially recognized when a zero sequence overcurrent is
detected. The faulted phase or phases are detected in a two stage system:
Algorithm
1. Algorithm is using delta principle to detect the faulty phase/phases.
2. Algorithm confirms the faulty phase with neutral current angle
comparison to the suspected faulted phase.
If there is a forward earth-fault in phase L1, its current increases to create calculated
or measured zero sequence current at phase angle of 0°. If there is reverse earth-
fault in phase L1, its current decreases to create calculated or measured zero
sequence current at a phase angle of 180°.
If there is forward earth-fault in phase L2, its current increases to create calculated
or measured zero sequence current at phase angle of -120°. If there is reverse
earth-fault in phase L2, its current decreases to create calculated or measured zero
sequence current at a phase angle of 60°.
Implementation
For compensated ground networks, the results of this algorithm are not
accurate or reliable. The algorithm depends on the network compensation
degree. For compensated networks, turn off this feature to avoid confusion or
false indications.
For high impedance earthed networks, the protection element includes a pull-
down menu in both setting groups. To permit the selection of grounding
network between RES or CAP. The RES selection is default selection and it is
for earthed networks. When the CAP selection is used, the I/O angle will be
corrected to the inductive direction of 90°. After that, the faulty phase detection is
made.
The possible detection, identification, and associated details for each condition
are listed in Table 26.
Table 26 - Earth-fault Phase Conditions
Condition Identification and Associated Details
FWD L1 Phase L1 increases above the set limit and two other phases remain inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is +/- 60° from L1 phase angle.
FDW L2 Phase L2 increases above the set limit and two other phases remain inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is +/- 60° from L2 phase angle.
FDW L3 Phase L3 increases above the set limit and two other phases remain inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is +/- 60° from L3 phase angle.
FWD L1-L2 Phase L1 and L2 increase above the set limit and phase L3 remains inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is between L1 and L2 phase angles.
FWD L2-L3 Phase L2 and L3 increase above the set limit and phase L1 remains inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is between L2 and L3 phase angles.
FWD L3-L1 Phase L3 and L1 increase above the set limit and phase L2 remains inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is between L3 and L3 phase angles.
FWD L1-L2-L3 All three phase currents increase above the set delta limit.
REV 1 (any one phase) One phase decreases below the set delta limit and other two phases remain inside the
delta limit.
REV 2 (any two phases) Two phases decrease below the set delta limit and third phase remains inside the delta
limit.
REV 3 (all three phases) All three phase currents decrease below the set delta limit.
Start
Io
ts tr Register
Block Event
Trip
Register
Event
Figure 58 - Block Diagram of the Earth-fault Stages I0>>, I0>>>, and I0>>>>
Start
Io
ts tr
Register
Block Event
Trip
Register
Event
Figure 57 shows a functional block diagram of the I0> earth overcurrent stage
with definite and inverse time operation. Figure 58 shows a functional block
diagram of the I0>>, I0>>>, and I0>>>> earth-fault stages with Definite
Time operation delay. This element can be configured to provide 50/51 G, GS
and N protection, depending on configuration.
Each stage can be connected to supervise any of these inputs and signals:
• Input I01 for all networks other than rigidly earthed.
• Input I02 for all networks other than rigidly earthed.
• Calculated signal I0Calc for rigidly and low impedance earthed networks
I0Calc = IL1 + IL2 + IL3.
Intermittent earth-faults cause protection to start, but does not cause a trip.
Here, a short fault means one cycle or more. For transient types of intermittent
earth-faults (shorter than 1 ms) in compensated networks, use a dedicated
stage Iot> 67NT. When engagement happens enough times, such intermittent
faults can be cleared using the intermittent time setting. When a new
engagement happens within the set intermittent time, the operation delay
counter is not cleared between adjacent faults and finally the stage trips.
By using I01 peak OR I02 peak, a 1-ms current peak is enough to start the stage
and increase the delay counter by 20 ms. For example, if the operating time is
120 ms. And the time between two peaks does not exceed the intermittent
time setting, the six peaks would initiate a trip.
Inverse delay means that the operation time depends on the amount the
measured current exceeds the pick-up setting. The bigger the fault current is,
the faster the operation. Accomplished inverse delays are available for the I0>
stage. The inverse delay types are described under Inverse Time Operation on
page 157. The Protection System shows a scalable graph of the configured
delay on the local panel display.
The scope of inverse curves with high pick-up settings is limited by:
• The maximum the measured secondary residual current 10 x I0N, and
• The maximum measured phase current 50 x IN
Setting Groups
There are two settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs, virtual
inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch
between setting groups.
Table 27 - Parameters of the Undirectional Earth-fault Stage I0> (50N/51N)(1)
Directional Transient
Intermittent Earth-fault- TIP This function is available only in voltage measurement modes. The modes
include direct -U0 measurement, for example, 2ULL+U0, but not, for
protection I0int> (67NI) example, in mode 3ULN. See Voltage Measurement Mode on
page 219.
Time (ms)
Direction Algorithm
I0 Pick-up Sensitivity
While the anti-alias filter of the relay attenuates the amplitude, the filter also
makes the pulses wider. When the current pulses are high enough, it is possible
to detect pulses, which have duration of >20% of the sampling interval.
Although the measured amplitude can be only a fraction of the actual peak
amplitude. It does not disturb the direction detection. The algorithm is more
sensitive to the sign and the timing of the I0 transient than sensitive to the
absolute amplitude of the transient. Thus a fixed value is used as a pickup level
for the I0.
The operation time of the transient stage I0INT> must be lower than the
settings of any directional earth-fault-stage. This setting avoids any unnecessary
trip from the Iφ>, Iφ>> stages. The start signals from the I0INT> stage can also
be used to block Iφ>, Iφ>> stages of parallel functions.
Auto Reclosing
The start signal of any Iφ> stage initiating auto-reclosing (AR) can be used to
block the I0INT> stage. This AR avoids the I0INT> stage with a long
intermittent setting, from interfering with the AR cycle in the middle of
discrimination time.
Usually the I0INT> stage itself is not used to initiate any AR. For transient
faults, the AR does not help because the fault phenomenon includes repeated
self-extinguishing.
Intermittent Time
Single transient-faults make the protection pick up, but does not cause a trip if
the stage has time to release between to successive faults. When starting
happens enough times, such intermittent faults can be cleared using the
intermittent time setting.
When a new fault happens within the set intermittent time, the operation
delay counter is not cleared between adjacent faults and finally the stage trips.
One transient fault is enough to start the stage and increase the delay counter
by 20 ms. For example, if operating time is 140 ms. And the intermittent time
setting between two peaks is not exceeded, then the seventh peak (in a 50-Hz
system) causes a trip (Figure 63).
The function starts operation delay calculation from the first peak. After the
second peak, in 80 ms the peak amount criteria is satisfied. At 160 ms, full-
operation time criteria is satisfied and the stage issues trip (Figure 60).
If the second peak does not come before the operational delay becomes full, the
stage is released after intermittent time has come full. But if the second peak
comes after operation time has come full but still inside intermittent time then
a trip is issued instantly (Figure 61).
If intermittent time comes full before operation delay comes full, the stage is
released (Figure 62). There are limitations to avoid incorrect settings. The
Algorithm assumes that peaks cannot come more often than 10 ms. If peak
amount is set to 10, then operation delay does not accept value less than
100 ms. If operational delay is set to 40 ms, it is not possible to set a higher peak
amount setting than 4. This setting prohibits the usage of settings that can
never be satisfied.
Time
Time
Setting Groups
There are two settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs, virtual
inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch
between setting groups.
Figure 63 - Block Diagram of the Directional Intermittent Transient Earth-fault Stage I0int>
I0 samples
I0 Start
I0 peak
TRANSIENT
ALGORITHM Register
Event
I0 fundamental DIV
freq. amplitude
U0 samples COUNTER
U0 Trip
CLEAR
U0 fundamental
Register
freq. amplitude Event
TOP
Block
Table 30 - Parameters of Directional Intermittent Transient Earth Fault Stage I0int> (67NI)
Table 30 - Parameters of Directional Intermittent Transient Earth Fault Stage I0int> (67NI)
There is detailed information available of the eight latest detected faults: Time
stamp, U0 voltage, elapsed delay, and setting group.
Capacitor Bank Unbalance The versatile capacitor, filter, and reactor bank protection can be enabled with
five current measurement inputs. The fifth input is useful for unbalance
Protection (50NC/51NC) current measurement of a double wye connected unearthed bank. The
unbalance protection is highly sensitive to internal faults of a bank because of
the natural unbalance compensation. The location method gives the
protection a new dimension and enables easy maintenance monitoring for a
bank.
This protection scheme is used in double wye connected capacitor banks. The
unbalance current is measured with a dedicated current transformer (could be
like 5A/5A) between two startpoints of the bank. System unbalance does not
affect the unbalance current. However, due to manufactured tolerances, some
amount of natural unbalance current exists between the startpoints. This
natural unbalance current affects the settings, so the setting must be increased.
Figure 64 - Typical, Capacitor Bank Protection Application with the 857 Protection System
L1
L2
L3
X1:1
857
X1:2 IL1 T1
X1:3
X1:4 IL2
X1:5
X1:6 IL3
X1:7
X1:8 I01
X1:9
I02
X1:10
VAMP 255
Compensation Method
This feature is implemented to the stage I0>>>>, while the other stage I0>>>
can still function as a normal unbalance protection-stage with compensation
method. Normally, the I0>>>> could be set as an alarming stage while stage
I0>>> trips the circuit-breaker.
Set the stage I0>>>> based on the calculated unbalance current change of one
faulty element. The calculated setting must be approximately 10% smaller than
the calculated value. There are tolerances in the primary equipment and in the
Protection System measurement circuit. The time setting of I0>>>> is not
used for tripping. The time setting specifies, how long the device must wait
until it is certain that there is a faulty element in the bank. After this time has
elapsed, the stage I0>>>> makes a new compensation automatically, and the
measured unbalance current for this stage is now zero.
IMPORTANT The automatic compensation does not effect on the measured unbalance
current of stage I0>>>.
When an element failure in the bank occurs, the algorithm checks the phase
angle of the unbalance current. This check is related to the phase angle of the
phase current IL1. Based on this angle, the algorithm can increase the
corresponding faulty elements counter (there are six counters).
Set for the stage I0>>>> to the allowed number of faulty elements. For
example if set to three elements, the fourth fault element issues the trip signal.
The fault location is used with internal fused capacitor and filter banks. There
is no need to use it with fuseless or external fused capacitor and filter banks,
nor with the reactor banks.
Zero Sequence Voltage The zero sequence voltage protection is used as unselective backup for earth-
faults. And for selective earth-fault-protections for motors having a unit
Protection U0>, U0>>(59N) transformer between the motor and the busbar.
When the measured value exceeds the pick-up setting of a particular stage, this
stage picks up and a start signal is issued. If the fault situation remains on
longer than the setting for the operation time delay, a trip signal is issued.
The zero sequence voltage can be measured with three voltage transformers,
one voltage transformer between the neutral point of the motor and earth. Or
calculated from the measured phase-to-neutral voltages according to the
selected voltage measurement mode (see Voltage Measurement Mode on
page 219):
• Phase: the zero sequence voltage is calculated from the phase voltages a
separate zero sequence voltage transformer is not needed. The setting
values are relative to the configured voltage transformer (VT) voltage/
√3.
• Line + U0: The zero sequence voltage is measured with voltage
transformer, for example with a broken delta connection. The setting
values are relative to the VT0 secondary voltage defined in
configuration.
There are two separately adjustable stages: U0> and U0>>. Both stages can be
configured for Definite Time operation characteristic. The zero sequence
voltage function comprises two separately adjustable zero sequence voltage
stages (stage U0> and U0>>).
Setting Groups
Each stage has four settings groups. Use digital and virtual inputs (mimic
display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch between setting
groups.
Figure 65 - Block Diagram of the Zero Sequence Voltage Stages U0> and U0>>
Start
Uo
ts tr
Register
Blocking Event
Trip
Register
Event
Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp, fault
voltage, elapsed delay, and setting group.
Table 35 - Recorded Values of the Residual Overvoltage Stages U0>, U0>> (59N)
Thermal Overload Protection The thermal overload function helps protects the motor in the motor mode or
cables in the feeder mode against excessive heating.
T> (49)
Thermal Model
The temperature is calculated using rms values of phase currents and a thermal
model according to IEC 60255-8. The rms value is calculated using harmonic
components up to the 15th.
2 2
I – IP
Trip time: t = τ • 1 n ----------------
2 2
-
I –a
Trip: a = k • kΘ • I mode
2
IP
Release time: t = τ • C τ • 1n --------------
-
a 2 – I 2
T = Operation time.
τ = Thermal time constant tau (setting value).
ln = Natural logarithm function.
I = Measured rms phase current (max. value of three phase
currents).
Ip = Preload current, I P = θ • k Θ • I n (If temperature rise is
120% θ=1.2). This parameter is the memory of the
algorithm and corresponds to the actual temperature rise.
k = Overload factor (Maximum continuous current), which is
service factor (setting value).
kΘ = Ambient temperature factor (permitted current due to
tamb). See Figure 49.
IMODE = The rated current (IN or IMOT ).
Cτ = Protection System constant for time to cool
(constant = Cτ x ). τ
If the fan motor is stopped, the cooling is slower than with an active fan.
Therefore there is a coefficient Cτ for thermal constant available. The
coefficient to be used as a cooling time constant, when current is less than 0.3 x
IMOT.
I MAX = k • k θ • I MODE
• IMAX40 is 1.0.
k
1.2
IMAX40
1.0
0.8 IMAX70
0.6
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80
AMB (°C)
When the Protection System is switched on, an initial temperature rise of 70%
is used. Depending on the actual current, the calculated temperature rise then
starts to approach the final value.
Alarm Function
Θoverload
Θmax
Θalarm
Reset ratio = 95%
Θp
Settings:
τ = 30 min.
k = 1.06
Θalarm = 90%
Alarm
Trip
I/IN
IMAX = k*IN IOVERLOAD = 1.05*IMAX
IP = 0.85*IN
Time
100 Min 200 Min 300 Min 400 Min 500 Min
Overvoltage Protection The overvoltage function measures the fundamental frequency component of
the line-to-line voltages regardless of the voltage measurement mode (see
U> (59) Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219). By using line-to-line voltages, any
phase-to-ground overvoltages during earth-faults have no effect (the earth-
fault-protection functions take care of earth-faults). Whenever any of these
three line-to-line voltages exceeds the pick-up setting of a particular stage, this
stage picks up and a start signal is issued. If the fault situation remains on
longer than the operation-time delay setting, a trip signal is issued.
In solidly earthed 4-wire networks, with loads between phase and neutral,
overvoltage protection can be needed for phase-to-ground voltages, too. In
these applications, the programmable stages can be used. See Programmable
Stages (99) on page 151.
There are three separately adjustable stages: U>, U>>, and U>>>. All stages
can be configured for Definite Time operation characteristic.
The U> stage has a settable release delay that enables the detection of
intermittent faults. The time counter of the protection function does not reset
immediately after the fault is cleared, but resets after the release delay has
elapsed. If the fault appears again before the release delay time has elapsed, the
delay counter continues from the previous value. The function trips if faults
occur frequently.
Configurable Hysteresis
Setting Groups
There are two settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs, virtual
inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch
between setting groups.
Figure 68 - Block Diagram of the Three-phase Overvoltage Stages U>, U>>, and U>>>
Im1 MAX
Im2 Start
Im3 ts tr
Register
Block Event
Trip
Register
Event
Table 37 - Parameters of the Overvoltage Stages U>, U>>, U>>> (59) (Continued)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Umax V The supervised value. Max. of U12, U23, and U31
U> V Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
U>>
U>>>
U> %Un Pick-up setting relative to UN Set(3)
U>>
U>>>
t> s Definite operation time Set(3)
t>>
t>>>
RlsDly s Release delay (U> stage only) Set(3)
Hyster 3 % Deadband size that is hysteresis Set(3)
(default)
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).
Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp, fault
voltage, elapsed delay, and setting group.
Table 38 - Recorded Values of the Overvoltage Stages (8 Latest Faults) U>, U>>, U>>> (59)
Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt %Un Maximum fault voltage
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during fault
Undervoltage Protection A basic undervoltage protection. The function measures the three line-to-line
voltages. Whenever the smallest of them drops below the pick-up setting of a
U< (27) particular stage, this stage picks up and a start signal is issued. If the fault
situation remains on longer than the operation-time delay setting, a trip signal
is issued.
As with all protection stages, the undervoltage function can be blocked with
any internal or external signal by using the block matrix. For example, if the
secondary voltage of one of the measuring transformers disappears because of a
fuse failure (see Voltage Transformer Supervision on page 185). The blocking
signal can also be a signal from the user logic (see Logic Functions on
page 249).
The stages can be blocked with a separate, low limit setting. With this setting,
the particular stage is blocked when the biggest of the three line-to-line
voltages drop below the given limit. The idea is to avoid tripping when the
voltage is switched off. If the operating time is less than 0.08 s, set the blocking
level to exceed 15% for the blocking action to be fast enough. The self-blocking
can be disabled by setting the low-voltage block limit equal to zero.
(A) The maximum of the three line-to-line voltages ULLmax is below the
block limit. Not regarded as an under voltage situation.
(B) The voltage ULLmin is above the block limit but below the pick-up level.
An undervoltage situation.
(C) Voltage is OK, because it is above the pick-up limit.
(D) An under voltage situation.
(E) Voltage is OK.
(F) An under voltage situation.
(G) The voltage ULLmin is under block limit and is not regarded as an under
voltage situation.
(H) An under voltage situation.
(I) Voltage is OK.
( J) Same as G.
(K) Voltage is OK.
E I K
C
Deadband
U< setting
H
D
B F
Block limit
J
A G
time
There are three separately adjustable stages: U<, U<<, and U<<<. They can be
configured for Definite Time (DT) operation characteristic.
Setting Groups
There are two settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs, virtual
inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch
between setting groups.
Table 39 - Parameters of the Undervoltage Stages U<, U<<, U<<< (27) (Continued)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common flag for Set(3)
On all stages and output relays, too. Automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.
MinU V The supervised minimum of line-to-line voltages in primary volts
U< V Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
U<<
U<<<
U< %Un Pick-up setting Set(3)
U<<
U<<<
t< S Definite operation time Set(3)
t<<
t<<<
LVBlk %Un Low limit for self-blocking Set(3)
RlsDly S Release delay (U< stage only) Set(3)
Hyster Default % Deadband setting Set(3)
3.0%
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).
Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults for each of the stages:
Time stamp, fault voltage, elapsed delay, voltage before the fault and setting
group.
Table 40 - Recorded Values of the Undervoltage Stages (8 Latest Faults) U<, U<<, U<<< (27)
Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt %Un Minimum fault voltage
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
PreFlt %Un Supervised value before fault, 1-s average value.
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during fault
Reverse Power and Reverse power function can disconnect a motor if the supply voltage is lost and
helps prevent power generation by the motor. Underpower function can detect
Underpower Protection the loss of load of a motor.
P<, P<<(32)
Reverse power and underpower function is sensitive to active power. For
reverse power function, the pick-up value is negative. For underpower
function, a positive pick-up value is used. Whenever the active power goes
under the pick-up value, the stage picks up and issues a start signal. If the fault
situation stays on longer than the delay setting, a trip signal is issued.
The pick-up setting range is from -200…200% of the Nom apparent power Sn.
The configured voltage and current transformer values determine the Nom
apparent power.
Equation 3.3
S n = ( VT RatedPrimary • CT RatedPrimary ) • 3
There are two identical stages available with independent setting parameters.
Overfrequency and Frequency protection is used for load sharing, loss of mains detection, and as a
backup protection for over-speeding.
Underfrequency Protection
f><, f>><< (81), (81H/81L) The frequency function measures the frequency from the two first voltage
inputs. At least one of these two inputs must have a voltage that is connected to
be able to measure the frequency. Whenever the frequency crosses the pick-up
setting of a particular stage, this stage picks up and a start signal is issued. If the
fault situation remains on longer than the operation delay setting, a trip signal
is issued. For situations where no voltage is present, an adapted frequency is
used.
The underfrequency stages are blocked when biggest of the three line-to-line
voltages are below the low-voltage block limit setting. With this common
setting (LVBlk), all stages in underfrequency mode are blocked when the
voltage drops below the given limit. The idea is to avoid purposeless alarms
when the voltage is off.
When the biggest of the three line-to-line voltages have been below the block
limit, the underfrequency stages are blocked until the pick-up setting is
reached.
There are four separately adjustable frequency stages: f><, f><><, f<, f<<. The
two first stages can be configured for overfrequency or underfrequency usage.
So totally four underfrequency stages can be in use simultaneously. The use of
programmable stages even more can be implemented (see Programmable
Stages (99) on page 151). All stages have definite operation-time delay (DT).
Setting Groups
There are four settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs,
virtual inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to
switch between setting groups.
Table 43 - Parameters of the Over and Underfrequency Stages
f><, f><><, f<, f<< (81H/81L)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common flag Set(3)
On for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.
f Hz The supervised value.
Hz Pick-up value: Set(3)
fx Over/under stage f><. See Mode.
fXX Over/under stage f><><
f< Under stage f<
f<< Under stage f<<
s Definite operation time: Set(3)
tX f>< stage
tXX f><>< stage
t< f< stage
t<< f<< stage
Mode Operation mode. (only for f>< and f><><): Set(3)
> Overfrequency mode
< Underfrequency mode
LVblck %Un Low limit for self-blocking. A common setting for all four Set(3)
stages.
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).
Table 44 - Recorded Values of the Over and Under Frequency Stages (Eight Latest Faults)
f><, f><><, f<, f<< (81H/81L)
Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt Hz Faulty frequency
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during fault
Rate of Change of Frequency Rate of change of frequency (ROCOF or df/dt) function is for fast Load-
shedding. The function is used to speed up operation time in over- and under-
(ROCOF) Protection df/dt frequency situations and to detect loss of grid. For example, a centralized
(81R) dedicated relay to shed load can be omitted and replaced with distributed
Load-shedding, if all outgoing feeders are equipped with 857 Protection
Systems.
Load switching and fault situations can generate a change in frequency. A load
drop can increase the frequency and increase in load can decrease the
frequency, for a while. The frequency can also oscillate after the initial change.
Over time, the control system of any local generator can drive the frequency
back to the original value. If there is a heavy short circuit fault or in case the
new load exceeds the generating capacity, the average frequency decreases.
TIME
START
TRIP
Settings Groups
There are four settings available and can be switched by using a digital input, a
virtual input, or manually.
ROCOF Implementation
The ROCOF function is sensitive to the absolute average value of the time
derivate of the measured frequency |df/dt|. Whenever the measured frequency
slope |df/dt| exceeds the setting value for 80-ms time a start signal is issued. The
ROCOF stage picks up and issues the start signal only after an additional 60-ms
delay. If the average |df/dt|, since the pick-up moment, still exceeds the setting,
when the operation delay time has elapsed, a trip signal is issued. In this Definite
Time mode, the second delay parameter “minimum delay, tMin” must be equal to
the operation delay parameter “t”.
If the frequency is stable for about 80 ms without a trip, the stage releases.
Figure 70 shows an example where the df/dt pick-up value is 0.5 Hz/s and the
delay settings are t=0.60 s and tMin=0.60 s. Equal times t = tMin gives DT delay
characteristics. Although the frequency slope fluctuates, the stage does not
release but continues to calculate the average slope since the initial pick-up. At
the defined operation time, t = 0.6 s, the average slope is 0.75 Hz/s. This value
exceeds the setting, and the stage trips.
At slope settings less than 0.7 Hz/s, the fastest possible operation time is
limited (Figure 71).
Figure 71 - At Very Sensitive Slope Settings, the Fastest Possible Operation Time Is Limited
The fastest possible
operation time is limited
according to this figure.
Fastest possible operation time settings
By setting the second delay parameter tMin smaller than the operational delay t,
an inverse type of operation time characteristics is achieved (Figure 72).
Figure 73 shows an example, where the frequency behavior is the same as in the
first figure. But the tMin setting is 0.15 s instead of being equal with t. The
operation time depends on the measured average slope according to this
equation.
s SET • t SET
- where,
t TRIP = --------------------------
s
The minimum operation time is limited by the setting parameter tMin. In the
example of the fastest operation time, 0.15 s, is achieved when the slope is
2 Hz/s or more. The leftmost curve in Figure 72 shows the inverse
characteristics with the same settings as in Figure 73.
0.5
0
Hz/
Hz
s
/s
0.7
2.0
5H
z/s
Hz/
49.7 TIME
s
START
TRIP
Synchrocheck Protection (25) A function that checks synchronism when the circuit-breaker or contactor is
closed. The function monitors voltage amplitude, frequency, and phase angle
difference between two voltages. Since there are two stages available, it is
possible to monitor three voltages. The voltages can be busbar and line or
busbar and busbar (bus coupler).
Table 48 - Measured and Recorded Values of Synchrocheck Stages SyC1, SyC2 (25)
Parameter Values Unit Description
Measured df - Hz Measured frequency difference
Values
dU - % Un / Measured voltage amplitude and phase angle difference
deg
UState - - Voltage status (for example DD)
SState - - Synchrocheck status
ReqTime - - Request time status
f (1) - Hz Measured frequency (reference side)
(1)
fy - Hz Measured frequency (comparison side)
(1)
U12 - % Un Measured voltage (reference side)
U12y(1) - % Un Measured voltage (comparison side)
Recorded ReqCntr - - Request counter
Values
SyncCntr - - Synchronizing counter
FailCntr - - Fail counter
f (1) - Hz Recorded frequency (reference side)
fy (1) - Hz Recorded frequency (comparison side)
U12 (1) - % Un Recorded voltage (reference side)
U12y (1) - % Un Recorded voltage (comparison side)
dAng - Deg Recorded phase angle difference, when close command is
given from the function
dAngC - Deg Recorded phase angle difference, when the circuit-breaker
actually closes.
EDly - % The elapsed time that is compared to the set request
timeout setting, 100% = timeout
(1) The labels (parameter names) change according to the voltage selection.
The signals of both the stages are available in the output matrix and the logic:
“Request”, “OK” and “Fail”. The “request” signal is active when a request has
received but the breaker is not yet closed. The “OK” signal is active when the
synchronizing conditions are met or the voltage check criterion is met. The
“fail”-signal is activated if the function fails to close the breaker or contactor
within the request timeout setting (Figure 74).
Sync Request
Sync OK
IMPORTANT The control pulse of the selected object must be long enough. For example,
if the voltages are in opposite direction, the synchronizing conditions are
met after several seconds.
Time Settings:
Synchrocheck: Max Synchronize Time (~seconds)
Object: Max Object Control Pulse len (~200 ms)
The application examples show the correct connection of the voltage inputs. In
Figure 76 and Figure 77, the applications require only one stage (voltage-
measuring modes are “1LL+U0/LLy” and “2LL/LLy”). Two stages are needed
for the application that is presented in Figure 78 (voltage-measuring mode is
“LL/LLy/LLz”).
1 -
- 0
+ U0 U12 1 -
Protection Functions
+
+
+ - 0
X3:17 Front
~
Communication
X3:18 option 1
Local port
X1:1 Remote port X9
U12y Extension port
X1:2 I L1 Communication
X1:3 option 2
X1:4 I L2 X10
X1:5
X1:6 I L3
X1:7 T1 X3:14
X1:8 I 01
X1:9 X3:15 +
X1:10 I 02 T2 X3:12
X1:11
X1:12 Ua X3:13 +
X1:13 T3 X7:17
+
X1:14 Ub
X1:17 X7:18 +
X1:18 Uc
T4 X7:15
Option Block
X6: 1 X7:16 +
X6: 2 X8:19
X6: 3 T5
X6: 4
X6: 5 X8:20
X6: 6 X8:17
T6
X6: 7
X8:18
X3: 1 +48V
DI 1 DI T7 X8:15
X3: 2
X3: 3 DI2
X3: 4 DI3 X8:16
857-3C7xxx
X3: 5 DI4
T8 X8:13
X7:14 Comm
A5 X2:1
X8: 1 DI21
DI22 DI
X8: 2 X2:2
X8: 3 Comm
IF X2:9
X8: 4 DI23
X8: 5 DI24 X2:10
X8: 6 Comm X2:11
X8: 7 DI25
X8: 8 DI26
X8: 9 Comm
X8:10 DI27
X8:11 DI28
X8:12 Comm
+ U 23 U12
1 -
+
- 0
X3:17 Front
~
X3:18 Communication
Local port option1
X1:1 Remote port X9
IL1 Extension port
X1:2 Communication
X1:3 option2
X1:4 IL2 X10
X1:5
X1:6 IL3
X1:7 T1 X3:14
X1:8 I01
X1:9 X3:15+
X1:10 I02 T2 X3:12
U12y X1:11
X1:12 Ua X3:13+
X1:13 T3 X7:17
X1:14 Ub
X1:17 Uc X7:18+
X1:18 T4 X7:15
Option Block
X6:1 X7:16+
X6:2 X8:19
X6:3 T5
X6:4
X6:5 X8:20
X6:6 T6 X8:17
+ X6:7
X8:18
X3:1 +48V
DI1 DI T7 X8:15
X3:2
X3:3 DI2
X3:4 DI3 X8:16
X3:5 DI4
DI5 T8 X8:13
X3:6
857-3C7xxx
X3:7 DI6
X8:14
X7:1 DI7 A1 X3:9
X7:13 DI18
X7:14 Comm X2:4
A5 X2:1
X8:1 DI21 DI
X8:2 DI22 X2:2
X8:3 Comm X2:9
X8:4 DI23 IF
X8:5 DI24 X2:10
X8:6 Comm X2:11
X8:7 DI25
Protection Functions
X8:8 DI26
X8:9 Comm
X8:10 DI27
X8:11 DI28
X8:12 Comm
147
Chapter 3
148
1 -
Chapter 3
- 0
Infeed 1
Protection Functions
+
U12y
M
X3:17 Front
~
X3:18 Communication
Localport option 1
X1: 1 Remote port X9
IL1 Extension port
X1: 2 Communication
X1: 3 option 2
X1: 4 IL2 X10
X1: 5
X1: 6 IL3
X1: 7 T1 X3:14
I01
+
X1: 8 X3:15
X1: 9
X1:10
I02 T2 X3:12
M
+
X1: 11 U 12 X3:13
X1:12
X1:13 T3 X7:17
X1:14 U12Y
+
X6: 1 X7:16
X6: 2 T5 X8:19
X6: 3
X6: 4
X6: 5 X8:20
X6: 6 T6 X8:17
X6: 7
U12
X8:18
X3: 1 +48V
DI1 DI T7 X8:15
X3: 2 DI2
X3: 3 DI3
X3: 4 X8:16
X3: 5 DI4 T8
DI5 X8:13
X3: 6
M
X3: 7 DI6
X8:14
857-3C7xxx
Infeed 2
1 -
- 0
Protection Functions Chapter 3
Magnetizing Inrush Second This stage is used to block other stages. The ratio between the second
harmonic component and the fundamental frequency component is measured
Harmonic O/C Stage on all phase currents. When the ratio in any phase exceeds the setting value, the
If2>(68F2) stage gives a start signal. After a settable delay, the stage gives a trip signal.
The start and trip signals can be used for blocking the other stages. The trip
delay is irrelevant if only the start signal is used for blocking. The trip delay of
the stages to be blocked must be more than 60 ms to make sure of a proper
block.
Im1
&
Im2
Im3 Max > ts tr
Start
Register
& Event
Block
t
Trip
Register
& Event
Table 51 - Measured and Recorded Values of Second Harmonic Blocking If2> (68F2)
Fifth Harmonic O/C Stage Overexcitation of a transformer creates odd harmonics. This fifth harmonic
overcurrent stage can detect overexcitation and block some other stages.
If5> (68F5)
The ratio between the fifth harmonic component and the fundamental
frequency component is measured on all phase currents. When the ratio in any
phase exceeds the setting value, the stage gives a start signal. After a settable
delay, the stage gives a trip signal.
The trip delay of the stages to be blocked must be more than 60 ms to make
sure of proper block.
Circuit Breaker Failure The (CBFP) feature is used to trip any upstream circuit breaker (CB). The trip
occurs if the fault does not disappear within a given time after the initial trip
Protection CBFP (50BF) command. Another output contact from the relay must be used for this backup
trip.
The operation of the CBFP is based on two criteria. The supervision of the
signal to the selected trip relay and the time the fault remains on after the trip
command.
If this time is longer than the operating time of the CBFP stage, the CBFP
stage activates another output relay. This output relay remains activated until
the primary trip relay is reset.
The CBFP stage is supervising all protection stages with the same selected trip
relay, since it supervises the control signal of this relay. See Output Matrix on
page 236 for details about the Output Matrix and the trip relays.
Table 53 - Parameters of the Circuit Breaker Failure Stage (50BF)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(2)
Trip F(2)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(3)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(3)
Table 54 - Recorded Values of the Circuit Breaker Failure Stage (Eight Latest Faults) CBFP
(50BF)
Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
Programmable Stages (99) For special applications, customized protection stages can be built by selecting
the supervised signal and the comparison mode.
Setting Groups
There are four settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs,
virtual inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to
switch between setting groups.
There are two identical stages available with independent setting parameters.
Table 56 - Parameters of the Programmable Stages PrgN (99)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F
Trip F
SCntr Cumulative start counter C
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status, forcing for test purposes. A common Set
On flag for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically
reset by a 5-minute timeout.
Link (See Table •) Name for the supervised signal Set
(See Table •) Value of the supervised signal
Cmp Mode of comparison: Set
> Over protection
< Under protection
Pickup Pick up value is scaled to primary level
Pickup pu Pick up setting in pu Set
Time stamp, fault value, and elapsed delay information for the eight latest
faults.
Arc Fault Protection (50ARC/ TIP This protection function needs optional hardware in slot X6. See Optional
50NARC) (Optional) Two-channel Arc Protection Card on page 337 (Chapter 9) and Arc Fault-
protection Stages (Option) on page 364 (Chapter 10).
Arc protection is for fast arc protection and elimination that is based on
simultaneous light and current measurement. Special arc sensors measure the
light of an arc.
There are three separate stages for the various current inputs:
• ArcI> For phase-to-phase arc faults. Current inputs IL1, IL2,
IL3 are used.
• ArcI01> For phase-to-earth arc faults. Current input I01 is used.
• ArcI02> For phase-to-earth arc faults. Current input I02 is used.
The light information source to the stages can be selected from this list.
• – No sensor is selected. The stage does not work.
• S1 Light sensor S1.
• S2 Light sensor S2.
• S1/S2 One of the light sensors S1 or S2.
• BI Binary input of the arc card. 48 Vdc.
• S1/BI Light sensor S1 or the binary input.
• S2/BI Light sensor S2 or the binary input.
• S1/S2/BI Light sensor S1 or S2 or the binary input.
Binary Input
The binary input (BI) on the arc option card can be used to get the light
indication from another Protection System to build selective arc protection
systems. See Optional Two-channel Arc Protection Card on page 337 for more
information.
The BI signal can also be connected to any of the output relays, BO, indicators,
and so on, offered by the output matrix (see Output Matrix on page 236). BI is
a dry input for 48-Vdc signal from binary outputs of other 857 Protection
Systems or dedicated compatible arc protection devices that are supplied by
Allen-Bradley®.
Binary Output
The binary output (BO) on the arc option card is used to give the light
indication signal or any other signal to another Protection System binary input.
The signal is used to build selective arc protection systems. See Optional Two-
channel Arc Protection Card on page 337 and Optional Digital I/O Card
(DI19/DI20) on page 338 (Chapter 9) for more details.
Selection of the BO connected signal is done with the output matrix (see
Measurement Functions on page 215). BO is an internally wetted 48V DC
signal for BI to other 857 Protection Systems or compatible dedicated arc
protection devices that are supplied by Allen-Bradley®.
The relay output matrix has a delayed light indication output signal (Delayed
ArcL>) available for building selective arc protection systems. Any light source
combination and a programmed delay can be configured starting from
0.01…0.15 s. The resulting signal is available in the output matrix to be
connected to any BO, output relays, and so on.
Pick-up Scaling
The per unit (pu) values for pickup setting are based on the current
transformer values.
• ArcI>: 1 pu = 1 x IN = rated phase current CT value
• ArcI01>: 1 pu = 1 x I01N = rated residual current CT value for input
I01
• ArcI02>: 1 pu = 1 x I02N = rated residual current CT value for input
I02
Table 58 - Parameters of Arc Protection Stages Arcl>, Arcl01>, Arcl02> (50 ARC / 50N ARC)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status – Status of the stage
Start Light is detected according to ArcIn F
Trip Light and overcurrent is detected F
LCntr Cumulative light indications counter. S1, S2, or BI. C
SCntr Cumulative light indication counter for the selected inputs C
according to parameter ArcIn
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C
Force Off Force flag for status, forcing for test purposes. A common flag Set
On for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.
Value of the supervised signal:
ILmax Stage ArcI>
Io1 Stage ArcI01>
Io2 Stage ArcI02>
ArcI> pu Pick up setting xIN Set
ArcIo1> pu Pick up setting xI01N
ArcIo2> pu Pick up setting xI02N
ArcIn Light indication source selection: Set
– No sensor that is selected
S1 Sensor 1 at terminals X6:4…5
S2 Sensor 2 at terminals X6:6…7
S1/S2
BI Terminals X6:1…3
S1/BI
S2/BI
S1/S2/BI
Table 58 - Parameters of Arc Protection Stages Arcl>, Arcl01>, Arcl02> (50 ARC / 50N ARC)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Delayed light signal output
Ldly s Delay for delayed light output signal Set
LdlyCn Light indication source selection: Set
– No sensor that is selected
S1 Sensor 1 at terminals X6:4…5
S2 Sensor 2 at terminals X6:6…7
S1/S2
BI Terminals X6:1…3
S1/BI
S2/BI
S1/S2/BI
Table 59 - Recorded Values of the Arc Protection Stages Arcl>, Arcl01>, Arcl02> (50 ARC / 50N ARC)
Inverse Time Operation The inverse-time operation, inverse delay minimum-time (IDMT), is available
for several protection functions. The common principle, formula, and graphic
representations of the available inverse delay types are described in this section.
Inverse delay means that the operation time depends on the measured real-time
process values during a fault. For example, with an overcurrent stage that uses
inverse delay a bigger fault current gives faster operation. The alternative to
inverse delay is definite delay. With definite delay, a preset time is used and the
operation time does not depend on the size of a fault.
Some protection functions have their own specific type of inverse delay. Details
of these dedicated inverse delays are described with the protection function.
Operation Modes
There are three operation modes to use the inverse time characteristics.
Standards delays Use standard delay characteristics by selecting a curve family (IEC, IEEE, IEEE2, RI)
and a delay type (Normal Inverse, Very Inverse, and so on).
Standard delay formula Select a curve family (IEC, IEEE, IEEE2) and define your own parameters for the
with free parameters selected delay formula. This mode is activated by setting delay type to
‘Parameters’, and change the delay function parameters from A to E. See Free
Parameter Settings with IEC, IEEE, and IEEE2 Equations on page 170.
Fully programmable Build the characteristics by setting 16 [current, time] points. The Protection
inverse delay System interpolates the values between given points with second degree
characteristics polynomials. This mode is activated by setting curve family to “PrgN”. There are a
maximum of three different programmable curves available simultaneously.
Each programmed curve is used by any number of protection stages.
See Programmable Inverse-time Curves on page 171.
The Protection System shows a graph of the currently used inverse delay on the
local panel display. Up and down keys can be used for zooming. Also the delays
at 20xISET, 4xISET, and 2xISET are shown.
If there are any errors in the inverse delay configuration, the protection stage
uses DT delay.
Limitation
The maximum measured phase current is 50xIN and the maximum directly
measured earth-fault current is 5xI0N. The full scope of inverse delay curves
goes up to 20 times the setting. At high setting, the maximum measurement
capability limits the scope of inverse curves according to Table 60.
Example 1 of Limitations:
CT = 750/5.
CT0= 100/1 (cable CT is used for residual current).
For overcurrent stage I>, Table 60 gives 12.5 A. The maximum setting for I>
stage that gives full inverse-delay range is 12.5 A /
5 A = 2.5 x IN = 1875 APrimary.
For earth-fault stage I0>, Table 60 gives 0.5 A. The maximum setting for I0>
stage that gives full inverse-delay range is 0.5 A / 1 A = 0.5 x I0N = 50 APrimary.
Example 2 of Limitations:
CT = 750/5.
For overcurrent stage I>, Table 60 gives 12.5 A. The maximum setting that
gives full inverse delay range, is 12.5 A / 4 A = 3.13 xIMOT = 1875 APrimary.
For earth-fault stage I0>, Table 60 gives 12.5 A. Thus the maximum setting for
I0> the stage that gives the full inverse delay range is 12.5 A /
5 A = 2.5 xI0N = 1875 APrimary.
The available standard inverse delays are divided in four categories IEC, IEEE,
IEEE2, and RI called delay curve families. Each category of family contains a
set of different delay types according to Table 61.
Limitations
The minimum, DT delay start is the latest when the measured value is 20 times
the setting. There are limitations at high setting values due to the measurement
range. See Table 61 for more details.
The operation time depends on the measured value and other parameters
according to Equation 3.4 . This equation can only be used to draw graphs or
when the measured value I is constant during the fault. A modified version is
implemented in the Protection System for real-time usage.
Equation 3.4
kA
t = --------------------------------
-
---------------
I B
–1
I pickup
There are three different delay types of according to IEC 60255-3, Normal
Inverse (NI), Extremely Inverse (EI), Very Inverse (VI), and a VI extension.
Additionally there is a Long Time Inverse (LTI).
k = 0.50
I = 4 pu (constant current)
Ipickup = 2 pu
A = 0.14
B = 0.02
• 0.14 = 5.0
t = 0.50
--------------------------
0.02
4--- –1
2
The operation time in this example is 5 seconds. The same result can be read
from Figure 80.
Figure 80 - IEC Normal Inverse Delay Figure 82 - IEC Extremely Inverse Delay
Figure 81 - IEC Very Inverse Delay Figure 83 - IEC Long Time Inverse Delay
There are three different delay types according to IEEE Std C37.112-1996
(MI, VI, EI) and many variations of these versions according to Table 63. The
IEEE standard defines inverse delay for both trip and release operations.
However, in the 857 Protection System, only the trip time is inverse according
to the standard but the release time is constant.
The operation delay depends on the measured value and other parameters
according to Equation 3.5 . This equation can only be used to draw graphs or
when the measured value I is constant during the fault. A modified version is
implemented in the Protection System for real-time usage.
Equation 3.5
A
t = k --------------------------------
-+B
---------------
I C
–1
I pickup
k = 0.50
I = 4 pu
Ipickup = 2 pu
A = 0.0515
B = 0.114
C = 0.02
The operation time in this example is 1.9 seconds. The same result can be read
from Figure 87.
Before 1996 and the release of ANSI standard C37.112, microprocessor relays
were using equations that approximated the behavior of various induction disc
types of relays. An approximation that is shown in Equation 8, which in the
protection system is called IEEE2. Another common name is IAC, from older
General Electric IAC relays that were modeled using the same equation.
There are four different delay types according toTable 64. The older
electromechanical induction disc relays have inverse delay for both trip and
release operations. However, in the 857Protection System, only the trip time is
inverse with the release time being constant.
The operation delay depends on the measured value and other parameters
according to Equation 3.6 . This equation can only be used to draw graphs or
when the measured value It is constant during the fault. A modified version is
implemented in the Protection System for real-time usage.
Equation 3.6
B D E
t = k A + ------------------------------
- + ---------------------------------
- + ---------------------------------
-
---------------
I
– C ---------------
I – C 2
---------------
I
– C 3
I I I
pickup pickup pickup
k = 0.50
I = 4 pu
Ipickup = 2 pu
A = 0.1735
B = 0.6791
C = 0.8
D = -0.08
E = 0.127
0.6791 - + -----------------------
– 0.08 - + -----------------------
0.127 - = 0.38
t = 0.5 0.1735 + ---------------------
2 3
4--- – 0.8 4--- – 0.8 4--- – 0.8
2 2 2
The operation time in this example is 0.38 seconds. The same result can be read
from Figure 90.
Figure 90 - IEEE2 Moderately Inverse Delay Figure 91 - IEEE2 Normal Inverse Delay
Figure 92 - IEEE2 Very Inverse Delay Figure 93 - IEEE2 Extremely Inverse Delay
These two inverse delay types have their origin in older ASEA (now ABB)
earth-fault Protection Systems.
The operation delay of types RI and RXIDG depends on the measured value
and other parameters according to Equation 3.7 - RI and Equation 3.8–
RXIDG . Actually these equations can only be used to draw graphs or when the
measured value I is constant during the fault. Modified versions are
implemented in the Protection System for real-time usage.
Equation 3.7 - RI
k
t RI = ----------------------------------------
-
0.236
0.339 – ---------------------
---------------
I
I pickup
I
t RXIDG = 5.8 – 1.351n -------------------
kI pickup
k = 0.50
I = 4 pu
Ipickup = 2 pu
0.5
t RI = --------------------------------- = 2.3
0.339 – 0.236 -------------
4---
2
The operation time in this example is 2.3 seconds. The same result can be read
from Figure 94.
Figure 94 - Inverse Delay of Type RI Figure 95 - Inverse Delay of Type RXIDG
k = 0.50.
I = 4 pu.
Ipickup = 2 pu.
4
t RXIDG = 5.8 – 1.351n ---------------- = 3.9
0.5 • 2
The operation time in this example is 3.9 seconds. The same result can be read
from Figure 95.
This mode is activated by setting delay type to “Parameters”. Edit the delay
function constants, parameters A to E. Use the standard equations with
constants instead of the standardized constants as in the previous chapter.
k = 0.50
I = 4 pu
Ipickup = 2 pu
A = 0.2078
B = 0.8630
C = 0.8000
D = –0.4180
E = 0.1947
0.8630 - + -----------------------
– 0.4180 - + -----------------------
0.1947 -
t = 0.5 0.2078 + --------------------- = 0.37
2 3
4--- – 0.8 4--- – 0.8 4--- – 0.8
2 2 2
The operation time in this example is 0.37 seconds. The resulting time/current
characteristic of this example matches with the characteristic of the old
electromechanical IAC51 induction disc relay.
Limitations
The minimum, DT delay start, is when the measured value is 20 times the
setting. However, there are limitations at high setting values due to the
measurement range. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157 for more details.
The [current, time] curve points are programmed by using the SetPointPS
software. The rules for defining the curve points are the following:
• The configuration must begin from the topmost line.
• The row order must be: the smallest current (longest operation time) on
the top. The largest current (shortest operation time) on the bottom.
• Fill all unused rows (on the bottom) with 1.00 in the Current I/I pickup
cells and 0.00 in the Operational delay cells.
The inverse-time setting error signal is activated, if interpolation with the given
points fails. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
Limitations
The minimum DT delay start is the latest when the measured value is 20 times
the setting. However, there are limitations at high setting values due to the
measurement range. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
86 Lockout Functionality
The 86 lockout functionality is provided for all protective elements trip and
status conditions and all output devices. It can be activated through the
latching functionality that is provided in the Output Matrix. When the
lockout functionality for an output relay or protective or control function is
activated, it must be manually or remotely reset. Determine the reason for the
for lockout condition before resetting the latched or lockout condition. Do not
automatically reset a lockout function without following proper safety
practices.
Support Functions
Event Log Event log is a buffer of event codes and time stamps, including date and time.
For example, each start-on, start-off, trip-on, or trip-off of any protection stage
has a unique event-number code. The code and the corresponding time stamp
are called an event.
Event log can also be scanned using the front panel or by using SetPointPS.
With SetPointPS, the events can be stored to a file if the relay is not connected
to any system. Some of the data is also available through the associated
communication interface.
Only the latest event can be read when using communication protocols or
SetPointPS. Every reading increments the internal read pointer to the event
buffer. If a communication error occurs, the latest event can be read any
number of times by using another parameter. On the local panel, the event
buffer can be scanned back and forth.
Event Enabling/Masking
An uninteresting event can be masked, which keeps the particular event from
being written in the event buffer.
The default setting allows for the 200 latest events in the event buffer. The
oldest one is overwritten, when a new event does occur (first in, first out). The
event buffer size can be modified to hold between 50…2000 events. The event
buffer size can be modified using the SetPointPS software, in the ALocal Panel
Conf menu. The Alarm screen can also be enabled in this same menu location
within the SetPointPS program. The shown resolution of a time stamp is 1
millisecond, but the actual resolution depends on the particular function that
creates the event. For example, most protection stages create events with 10 ms
or 20-ms resolution. The absolute accuracy of all time stamps depends on the
time synchronization of the relay. See System Clock and Synchronization on
page 195.
The normal procedure is to poll events from the device every time. If not done,
the event buffer eventually overflows. On the local screen, overflow is indicated
with string “OVF” after the event code.
Disturbance Recorder The 12 channel disturbance recorder can be used to record all measured
signals. Such as, currents, voltages, and the status information of digital inputs
(DI) and digital outputs (DO). The digital inputs include the arc protection
signals S1, S2, BI, and BO, if the optional arc protection is available. It can be
useful for troubleshooting applications and controls during commissioning or
abnormal events.
Any start or trip signal from any protection stage, or by a digital input, triggers
the recorder. The triggering signal is selected in the output matrix (vertical
signal DR). The recording can also be triggered manually. All disturbance
recordings have a time stamp.
The recordings can be uploaded, viewed, and analyzed with the SetPointPS
program. The disturbance recordings are in COMTRADE format. Other
programs can be used to view and analyze the recordings that are made by the
relay.
Number of Channels
Virtual COMTRADE Files Virtual COMTRADE files can be run with the 857 Protection Systems. Relay
behavior can be analyzed by replaying the recorder data repeatedly in the relay
memory.
Use the SetPointPS programming tool to open the file. See SetPointPS
software publication 857-PM001 for details.
3. Select the COMTRADE file from the hard disk or other source
location.
SetPointPS is now ready to read the recording.
5. Click the Refresh icon to send record data to the relay, which takes a few
seconds.
6. Click the Go icon to initiate playback of the file.
The “Change to control mode” button takes you back to the virtual
measurement.
TIP The sample rate of the COMTRADE file must be 32/cycle (625φs when 50 Hz
is used). The channel names have to correspond to the channel names in the
857 Protection System: IL1, IL2, IL3, Io1, Io2, U12, U23, UL1, UL2, UL3, and Uo.
This signal is available for use within the output matrix and the blocking
matrix. Virtual outputs of the output matrix of the group control setting can be
used.
This signal is available for both the output and the blocking matrix. Use of
virtual outputs of the output matrix for the setting group control is possible.
By setting the Pickupf2 parameter for If2/If1 to zero, the inrush signal behaves
equally with the cold load pick-up signal.
IMPORTANT Inrush detection is based on an FFT calculation, which requires a full cycle of
data for analyzing the harmonic content.
IMPORTANT Inrush detection is based on FFT (Fast Fourier Transform) calculation, which
requires full cycle of data for analyzing the harmonic content.
When using the inrush function for blocking and the current rise is noticed,
use the start conditions for cold load pick-up to activate the inrush blocking.
After the Cold load pick-up rgw c=blocking is continued if:
• A second harmonic component is in the signal
And
• The inrush current detection six Supporting functions first cycle.
Otherwise the second harmonic based blocking signal is released.
Inrush blocking is recommended in time delayed overcurrent stages, while
non-blocked instant overcurrent stage is set to 20% higher than expected
inrush current. By this scheme, fast reaction time (in short circuit faults
during the energization) can be achieved while the inrush function blocks
the time delayed stages.
Idle
Cold load
1. No activation because the current has not been under the set Idle current.
2. Current dropped under the Idle current level but now it stays between
the Idle current and the pick-up current for over 80 ms.
3. No activation because the phase two lasted longer than 80 ms.
A cold load activation exists, which lasts as long as the operation time
was set. Or as long as the current stays above the pick-up setting.
Voltage Sags and Swells One of the most important power quality functions are voltage sag and swell
monitoring. The power quality of electrical networks and the sophisticated
loads (for example computers) requires an uninterruptible supply of “clean”
electricity. The 857 Protection System provides many power quality functions
that can evaluate, monitor, and alarm that is based on the power quality.
The protection system provides separate logs to monitor sags and swells. The
voltage log is triggered if any voltage input goes under the sag limit (U<) or
exceeds the swell limit (U>). There are four registers for both sags and swells in
the fault log. Each register has start time, phase information, duration,
minimum, average, maximum voltage values of each sag and swells event. There
is total number of sags and swells counters, and total timers for sags and swells.
The voltage power quality functions are located under the submenu “U”.
Current Transformer The 857 Protection System can supervise the external wiring between the
protection system terminals and current transformers (CT) and the CT
Supervision themselves. Also is a safety function, as an open secondary on a CT can cause
dangerous voltages.
One of the three phase currents drops below Imin< setting, while, another
phase current is exceeding the Imax> setting.
Voltage Transformer The 857 Protection System supervises the VTs and VT wiring between the
relay terminals and the VTs. If there is a blown fuse in the voltage transformer
Supervision circuitry, the prevented or distorted voltage measurement could issue an alarm.
In some applications, protection functions that use voltage signals are blocked
to avoid a spurious trip.
The VT supervisor function measures the three phase voltages and currents.
The negative sequence voltage U2 and the negative sequence current I2 are
calculated. The function issues an alarm after the operation delay has elapsed
if:
• U2 exceeds the U2> setting and simultaneously;
• I2 is less than the I2< setting.
Circuit Breaker Condition The 857 Protection System has a monitoring function for conditions that
supervises the wearing of the circuit-breaker. The condition monitoring can
Monitoring give alarms for the need of CB maintenance well before the CB condition is
critical.
If the wearing characteristics of the CB, or part of it, is a straight line on a log/
log graph. The two endpoints are enough to define that part of the
characteristics. The device uses logarithmic interpolation for any current values
that fall in between the given current points 2–8.
The points 4–8 are not needed for the CB in Figure 98. They are set to 100 kA
and the algorithm discards one operation.
100000
10000
Number of Permitted Operations
1000
100
50
20
10
100 200 500 1000 10000 100000
Current (A)
TIP The values in Table 77are taken from Figure 98. The table is edited with
SETPOINTPS under menu “BREAKER CURVE”.
There are two alarm points available, each having two setting parameters each.
• Current
The first alarm can be set, for example, to nominal current of the CB or
any application typical current. The second alarm can be set, for
example, according to a typical fault current.
Any actual interrupted currents are logarithmically weighted for the two given
alarm current levels. The number of operations that are left at the alarm points
is decreased accordingly. When the “operations left” goes under the given
alarm limit, an alarm signal is issued to the output matrix. An event is
generated depending on the event enabling.
The operations that are left can be read from the counters “Al1Ln” (Alarm 1)
and “Al2Ln” (Alarm 2). There are three values for both alarms, one for each
phase. The two alarm functions supervise the smallest of the three values.
Logarithmic Interpolation
Equation 4.1
a-
C = ---
n , where
I
C = Permitted operations
I = Interrupted current
a = Constant according to Equation 4.2
n = Constant according to
Equation 4.2
Ck
1n -------------
Ck + 1
n = -------------------
-
Ik + 1
1n -----------
Ik
Equation 4.3
a = C k I k2
The current 6 kA lies between points 2 and 3 in the table. That gives value for
the index k. Using:
k = 2
Ck = 10000
Ck+1 = 80
Ik+1 = 31 kA
Ik = 1.25 kA
And the Equation 4.2 and Equation 4.3, the device calculates
10000
1n ---------------
80 = 1.5038
n = ---------------------
31000
1n ---------------
1250
1.5038 6
a = 10000 • 1250 = 454 • 10
Using Equation 4.1, the device gets the number of permitted operations for
current 6 kA.
6
454 • 10 - = 945
C = -----------------------
1.5038
6000
If the Equation 4.1 and values n and a (from the previous example) are used,
the device gets the number of permitted operations at 10 kA.
6
454 • 10 - = 313
C 10kA = --------------------------
1.5038
12500
Equation 4.4
C AlarmMax
∆ = -------------------------
C
945
∆ L1 = ∆ L2 = --------- = 3
313
The decrement of Alarm 2 counters is 3 for phases L1 and L2. In phase L1, the
currents are less than the alarm limit current 6 kA. For such currents, the
decrement is one.
∆ L3 = 1
Energy Pulse Outputs The 857 Protection System can be configured to send a pulse whenever certain
amount of energy is imported or exported. The principle is presented in
Figure 99. Each time the energy level reaches the pulse size, an output relay is
activated. The output relay stays active as long as defined by a pulse duration
setting.
Configurable:
100…5000 ms
Configurable:
10…10000 kWh
kvarh
The device has four energy pulse outputs. The output channels are:
• Active exported energy.
• Reactive exported energy.
• Active imported energy.
• Reactive imported energy.
Each channel can be connected to any combination of the output relays with
output matrix. The parameters for the energy pulses can be found in the E
menu under the submenus E-PULSE SIZES and E-PULSE DURATION.
Scaling Examples
Example 1
This example is not a practical scaling example unless an output relay lifetime
of about six years is accepted.
Example 2
Example 3
Example 4
Figure 100 - Application Example of Wiring the Energy Pulse Outputs to a PLC Having Common
Plus and Using an External Wetting Voltage
Pulse counter-input 1
Active exported
energy pulses (+E)
Pulse counter-input 2
Reactive exported
energy pulses (+Eq)
Pulse counter-input 3
Active imported
energy pulses (- E)
Pulse counter-input 4
Reactive imported
energy pulses (- Eq)
−
Figure 101 - Application Example of Wiring the Energy Pulse Outputs to a PLC Having Common
Minus and Using an External Wetting Voltage
+
PLC
Active exported
energy pulses (+E)
Pulse counter-input 1
Reactive exported
energy pulses (+Eq)
Pulse counter-input 2
Active imported
energy pulses (- E)
Pulse counter-input 3
Reactive imported
energy pulses (- Eq)
Pulse counter-input 4
Figure 102 - Application Example of Wiring the Energy Pulse Outputs to a PLC Having Common
Minus and an Internal Wetting Voltage
Active exported
Pulse counter-input 1
energy pulses (+E)
Active imported
Pulse counter-input 3
energy pulses (- E)
Reactive imported
Pulse counter-input 4
energy pulses (- Eq)
System Clock and The internal clock of the device is used to time stamp events and disturbance
recordings. The system clock must be externally synchronized to get event time
Synchronization stamps that are comparable for all relays in the system.
The synchronizing is based on the difference of the internal time and the
synchronizing message or pulse. This deviation is filtered and the internal time
is corrected softly towards a zero deviation.
Time zone offset (or bias) can be provided to adjust the local time for IED. The
Offset can be set as a Positive (+) or Negative (-) value within a range of -
15.00…+15.00 hours and a resolution of 0.01/h. Basically quarter hour
resolution is enough.
DST time standards vary widely throughout the world. Traditional daylight/
summer time is configured as 1-hour positive bias. The current US/Canada
DST standard, adopted in 2007 is: 1-hour positive bias, starts at 2:00 a.m. on
the second Sunday in March, and ends at 2:00 a.m. on the first Sunday in
November.
In the European Union, daylight change times are defined relative to the UTC
time of day instead of local time of day (as in U.S.). European customers, verify
your local rules for DST.
To correct the clock error, if the system clock has a steady drift and no external
synchronizing source is available, edit the parameters “AAIntv” and “AvDrft”.
Use this equation if the previous “AAIntv” value has been zero:
604.8
AAIntv = --------------------------------------------
-
DriftInOneWeek
If the auto-adjust interval “AAIntv” has not been zero, but further trimming is
still needed. Use this equation to calculate a new auto-adjust interval:
1
AAIntv = -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
1 DriftInOneWeek
-------------------------------------------- + ---------------------------------------------
AAIntv PREVIOUS 604.8
The term DriftInOneWeek/604.8 can be replaced with the relative drift that is
multiplied by 1000, if some other period than one week has been used. For
example if the drift has been 37 seconds in 14 days, the relative drift is
37 x 1000/(14 x 24 x 3600) = 0.0306 ms/s.
Example 1
If there is no external sync and the device clock is leading 61 seconds a week
and the parameter AAIntv is 0, the parameters are set as:
AvDrft = Lead
AAIntv = 604.8
------------- = 9.9s
61
With these parameter values, the system clock corrects itself with –1 ms every
9.9 seconds, which equals –61.091 s/week.
Example 2
If external sync is unavailable, the device clock lags 5 seconds in 9 days, and the
AAIntv is 9.9 s, then the parameters are set as:
1
AAIntv NEW = --------------------------------------------- = 10.6
1 5000
------- – -------------------------------
9.9 9 ( 24 • 3600 )
AvDrft = Lead
TIP When the internal time is roughly correct, deviation is less than 4 seconds,
any synchronizing or auto-adjust does not turn the clock backwards.
Instead, in case the clock is leading, it is softly slowed to maintain causality.
The clock can be synchronized by reading minute pulses from digital inputs,
virtual inputs, or virtual outputs. Sync source is selected with SyncDI setting.
When a rising edge is detected from the selected input, system clock is adjusted
to the nearest minute. The digital input pulse must be at least 50 ms. Delay of
the selected digital input must be set to zero.
Synchronization Correction
If the sync source has a known offset delay, it can be compensated with SyOS
setting. This setting is useful when compensating for hardware delays or
transfer delays of communication protocols. A positive value compensates a
lagging external sync and communication delays. A negative value compensates
any leading offset of the external sync source.
Sync Source
When the device receives new sync message, the sync source display is updated.
If no new sync messages are received within next 1.5 minutes, the device
changes to internal sync mode.
IRIG-B003 input clock signal voltage-level is TLL. The input clock signal that
is originated in the GPS receiver must be taken to multiple relays through an
IRIG-B distribution module. This module acts as a centralized unit for a
point-to-multiple point connection.
IMPORTANT Daisy chain connections of IRIG-B signal inputs to multiple relays must be
avoided.
IRIG B
GPS
Distribution
Receiver
Module
Deviation
The time deviation means how much the system clock time differs from sync
source time. Time deviation is calculated after receiving new sync message. The
filtered deviation means how much the system clock was adjusted and takes
care of small errors in sync messages.
Auto-Lag/Lead
The device synchronizes to the sync source, meaning it starts automatically
leading or lagging to stay in perfect sync with the master. The learning process
takes few days.
The Running Hour Counter This function calculates the total active time of the selected digital input,
virtual I/O, or output matrix output-signal. The resolution is ten seconds.
Timers The 857 Protection System includes four settable timers. These timers can be
used together with the programmable logic. Or to control setting groups and
other applications that require actions that are based on calendar time. Each
timer has its own independent settings. The selected on-time and off-time is
set. The activation of the timer can be set as daily or according to the day of
week (See the setting parameters for details). The timer outputs are available
for logic functions and for the block and output matrix.
(not in use)
Daily
Monday
Tuesday
Wednesday
Thursday
Friday
Saturday
Sunday
MTWTF
MTWTFS
Sat/Sun
Any timer that is in use on or off can be forced by writing a new status value.
No forcing flag is needed, as in, for example, forcing the output relays.
The forced time is valid until the next forcing or until the next reversing timed
act from the timer itself.
The status of each timer is stored in nonvolatile memory when the auxiliary
power is switched off. At startup, the status of each timer is recovered.
Combined Overcurrent Status This function collects faults, fault types, and registered fault currents of all
enabled overcurrent stages.
Table 83 - Line Fault Parameters
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
IFltLas xImode Current of the latest overcurrent fault (Set)(3)
LINE ALARM
AlrL1 Start (=alarm) status for each phase:
AlrL2 0 0=No start since alarm ClrDly
AlrL3 1 1=Start is on
OCs Combined overcurrent start status:
0 AlrL1=AlrL2=AlrL3=0
1 AlrL1=1 orAlrL2=1 or AlrL3=1
LxAlarm “On” Event enabling for AlrL1…3: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
LxAlarmOff “Off” Event enabling for AlrL1…3: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
OCAlarm “On” Event enabling for combined o/c starts: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
OCAlarmOff “Off” Event enabling for combined o/c starts: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
IncFltEvnt Disabling several start and trip events of the same fault: Set(4)
On Several events are enabled(1)
Off Several events of an increasing fault are disabled(2)
ClrDly 0…65535 s Duration for active alarm status AlrL1, Alr2, AlrL3, and OCs Set(4)
LINE FAULT
FltL1 Fault (=trip) status for each phase:
FltL2 0 0=No fault since fault ClrDly
FltL3 1 1=Fault is on
OCt Combined overcurrent trip status:
0 FltL1=FltL2=FltL3=0
1 FltL1=1 or FltL2=1 or FltL3=1
LxTrip “On” Event enabling for FltL1…3: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
LxTripOff “Off” Event enabling for FltL1…3: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
OCTrip “On” Event enabling for combined o/c trips: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
Self-supervision The functions of the micro controller, the associated circuitry, and the program
execution are supervised with a separate watchdog circuit. The watchdog
circuit supervises the device and attempts to restart the micro controller in a
fault situation. If the restart fails, the watchdog issues a self-supervision alarm
to indicate a permanent internal fault.
When the watchdog circuit detects a permanent fault, it blocks any control of
other output relays (except for the self-supervision output relay).
In addition, the internal supply voltages are supervised. If the auxiliary supply
of the device disappears, an alarm is automatically given because the internal
fault (IF) output relay functions on a working current principle. The IF relay is
energized when the auxiliary supply is on and no internal fault is detected.
Diagnostics
The device runs self-diagnostic tests for hardware and software in every boot
sequence and also accesses runtime checking.
Fatal Errors If fatal error has been detected, the device releases IF relay contact and error
status indicator is set on. Local panel also displays an error message about the
detected fault. Fatal error state is entered when the device cannot handle
protections.
Runtime Errors When self-diagnostic function detects a fault, Selfdiag Alarm matrix signal is set
and an event (E56) is generated. In case the error was only temporary, an off event
is generated (E57). Self-diagnostic error can be reset through local panel
interface.
Error Registers There are four 16-bit error registers that are readable through remote protocols.
Table 84 shows the meaning of each error register and their bits.
Incomer Short Circuit Fault The 857 Protection System includes a standalone fault locator algorithm. The
algorithm can locate a short circuit in radial operated networks. The fault
Locator (Feeder Mode) location is given as in reactance (ohms) and kilometers. The fault value can
then be exported, for example, with the event log to a Distribution
Management System (DMS). The system can then localize the fault. If a DMS
is not available, the distance to the fault is displayed as kilometers, and a
reactance value. However, the distance value is valid only if the line reactance is
set correctly.
The wire type of the line must be the same for the whole length. If there are
several wire types on the same line, use the value of average line reactance to get
an approximate distance value to the fault. Examples of line reactance values:
Overhead wire Line A: 0.408 Ω/km and Line B: 0.378 Ω/km).
The fault locator is normally used in the incoming bay of the substation. The
fault location is obtained for the whole network with just one device.
Table 87 - Measured and Recorded Values of Incomer Short Circuit Fault Locator
Parameter Value Unit Description
Distance km Distance to the fault
Xfault ohm Fault reactance
Date — Fault date
Time — Fault time
Time ms Fault time
Cntr — Number of faults
Pre A Pre-fault current (=load current)
Fault A Current during the fault
Post A Post-fault current
Udrop % Un Voltage dip during the fault
Durati s Fault duration
Type — Fault type (1-2,2-3,1-3,1-2-3)
Currents
Pre-fault time Fault time with the Breaker Operation Time included; Post-fault
more than must be 0.08…1 s. only a few
In case the digital input is used together with the currect change, the
input signal must be activated >0.5 s after the fault occurs.
Figure 105 is an application example where the fault location algorithm is used
at the feeder side.
Voltages
Currents
Pre-fault time Fault time with the Breaker Operation Time included; Post-fault
more than must be 0.08…1 s. only a few
In case the digital input is used together with the current change, the
input signal must be activated >0.5 s after the fault occurs.
Feeder Fault Locator The device includes a standalone fault locator algorithm. The algorithm can
locate a short circuit and earth-fault in radial operated networks. The fault
location is given as in reactance (ohms) and kilometers. Fault value can then be
exported, for example, with event to a Distribution Management System
(DMS). The system can then localize the fault. If a DMS is not available, the
distance to the fault is displayed as kilometers and a reactance value.
The distance value is valid only if the line reactance is set correctly. The wire
type of the line must be the same for the whole length. If there are several wire
types on the same line, use an average line reactance value to get an
approximate distance value to the fault. Examples of line reactance values:
Overhead wire Line A: 0.408 Ω/km and Line B: 0.378 Ω/km).
This fault locator cannot be used in incomer because this locator has not
ability to compensate healthy feeders away. When feeder fault locator is
calculating short circuit impedance, this formula is used:
UA – UB
Z AB = --------------------
-
IA – IB
When feeder fault locator is calculating ground fault impedance, this formula
is used:
UA
Z A = ----------------------------
-
I A + k + 3I 0
The fault reactance calculation is triggered when the “Pick-up setting” value is
exceeded. Or if both “Pick-up setting” and “Triggering digital input” terms are
configured and fulfilled. When used, “Triggering digital input” can be digital
or virtual input.
VO1…VO6
NI1…NI64
POC1…POC16
Line reactance 0.010 … 10.000 Ohms/km 0.491 Line reactance of the line. Used only to convert
the fault reactance to kilometers.
Earth factor 0.000…10.000 — 0.678 Calculated earth factor from line specifications.
Earth factor angle -60…60 ° 10 Angle of calculated earth factor from line
specifications.
Earth-fault Location The 857 Protection System includes a sophisticated standalone earth-fault
location algorithm that can locate an earth-fault accurately in radically
operated compensated earthed networks.
The function can locate a fault only if the fault resistance is less than 50 ohms.
The fault location is given in reactance value. This value can then be exported,
for example, with event to a DMS (Distribution Management System). The
system can then localize the fault and display it on a map.
The fault location must be used in the incoming bay of the substation. It can be
obtained for the whole network with just one 857 Protection System. A cost-
effective upgrade of an existing system.
The reactance value is converted to distance in the DMS by using this formula:
3•X -
s = -------------------------------- , where
X0 + X1 + X2
s = Distance in km
X = Reactance. Calculated by the 857 Protection System
X0 = Zero sequence reactance per kilometer of the line
X1 = Positive sequence reactance per kilometer of the line
X2 = Negative sequence reactance per kilometer of the line
Algorithm Functions
1. The measurements of phase currents and voltages are continuously
available.
2. The fault distance calculation can be triggered in two ways. By a digital
input to switch the secondary resistor ON or OFF, or by a change in
earth-fault or negative sequence current.
3. The fault phase is identified and the voltage of the faulted phase is
decreased at least by half.
4. The fault distance is calculated by dividing the change of the voltage by
the change of the negative sequence current.
5. Only the imaginary part is used, so then the reactance is solved.
Measurement Functions
10 Load = 0% 100
0 0
-5
IL2
-10
Table 95 - Frequency
Measurement Range 16…75 Hz
Inaccuracy ±10 MHz
The 857 Protection System calculates the RMS value of each phase current.
The minimum and the maximum of RMS values are recorded and stored (see
Minimum and Maximum Values on page 218).
I rms = I f 12 + I f 22 + … + I f 152
RMS Voltages
The 857 Protection System calculates the RMS value of each voltage input.
The minimum and the maximum of RMS values are recorded and stored (see
Minimum and Maximum Values on page 218).
U rms = U f 12 + U f 22 + … + U f 152
Harmonics and Total The 857 Protection System calculates THDs as percentage of the base
frequency for currents and voltages. The device calculates the harmonics from
Harmonic Distortion (THD) the second to the 15th of phase currents and voltages. The 17th harmonic
component is shown partly in the value of the 15th harmonic component, due
to the nature of digital-sampling. The harmonic distortion is calculated using
the equation.
15
hi
2
i=2 - , where
THD = -------------------
h1
h1 = Fundamental value
h2…15 = Harmonics
Example:
h1 = 100 A
h3 = 10 A
h7 = 3A
h11 = 8A
2 2 2
10 + 3 + 8 - = 13.2%
THD = -----------------------------------
100
Another way to calculate THD is to use the RMS value as reference instead of
the fundamental frequency value. In the example above, the result would be
13%.
Demand Values The device calculates an average value of the phase currents IL1, IL2, IL3, and
power values S, P, and Q. The demand time is configurable from 10…30
minutes with parameter “Demand time”.
Minimum and Maximum Minimum and maximum values are registered with a time stamp (since the last
manual clear or since the last device restart). The available registered minimum
Values and maximum values are listed in this table.
Maximum Values of the Last Some minimum and maximum values of the last 31 days and the last 12
months are stored in the nonvolatile memory of the device. The corresponding
31 Days and 12 Months time stamps are stored for the last 31 days.
The value can be a one cycle value or an average, according to the Time Base
parameter.
Voltage Measurement Mode The Bulletin 857 can be connected to line-to-line or phase-to-ground voltages.
The connection is dependent on the application and available voltage
transformers. Set the configuration parameter “Voltage measurement mode”
according to the used connection. The available modes are:
Table 105 - Available Voltage Measurement Modes
Mode Description
“2LL+Uo” The device is connected to line-to-line voltages U12 (X1-11 and X1-12) and U23 (X1-13
and X1-14). Also to zero sequence voltage U0 (X1-17 and X1-18). The phase-to-ground
voltages are calculated. The network must use only three wires. Any neutral wire must not
exist (two PTs/VTs in open delta).
“3LN” The device is connected to phase-to-ground voltages UL1 (X1-11 and X1-12), UL2 (X1-13
and X1-14), and UL3 (X1-17 and X1-18). The zero sequence voltage is calculated. A neutral
wire can exist (three PTs/VTs “Y” connected).
Power Calculations The power calculations in the 857 are dependent on the voltage measurement
mode (see Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219).
Line-to-Line Voltages
When the 857 is connected to line-to-line voltages, the voltage measurement
mode is set to equal to “2LL+Uo”. The following Aron equation is used for
power calculation.
Apparent power, active power, and reactive power are calculated as follows:
S=|S|
P = real( S)
Q = imag( S)
cos ϕ = P
---
S
Line-to-Neutral Voltages
Apparent power, active power, and reactive power are calculated similarly as
with line-to-line voltages by using the following equation:
S=|S|
P = real( S)
Q = imag( S)
cos ϕ = P
---
S
Direction of Power and Figure 110 shows the concept of three-phase current direction and sign of cosϕ
and power factor PF. Figure 111 shows the same concepts, but on a PQ-power
Current plane.
-inductive +Capacitive
Reverse inductive power current Forward capacitive power
is leading current is leading
cosφ = - cosφ = +
PF = + PF = -
-Capacitive
Reverse capacitive power current is +Inductive
lagging Forward inductive power
cosφ = - current is lagging
PF = - cosφ = +
PF = +
-Capacitive +inductive
Reverse capacitive power Forward inductive power
current is lagging current is lagging
cosφ = - cosφ = +
PF = - PF = +
-Inductive +Capacitive
Reverse inductive power current Forward capacitive power
is lagging current is leading
cosφ = - cosφ = +
PF = + PF = -
Symmetric Components In a three-phase system, the voltage or current phasors can be divided in the
symmetric components:
• Positive sequence 1.
• Negative sequence 2.
• Zero sequence 0.
S 1 1 1 U
0 1---
S = 1 a a 2 V , where
1 3
S2 1 a2 a W
3
a = 1 ∠120° = – 1--- + j ------- , a phasor rotating constant
2 2
U1 1 2 U
= --- 1 – a 12
, where
U2 3 1 –a U
23
TIP The zero sequence or residual measurement signals connected to the device
are -U0 and 3I0. However, usually the name “I0” is used instead of the correct
name “3I0”
UN = 100V
Voltage measurement mode is “2LL+Uo”.
Injection:
Ua = U12= 100V
Ub = U23= 0
U1 = 33%
U2 = 33%
U2/U1 = 100%
When using a single-phase test device, the relative unbalance U2/U1 is 100%.
UN = 100V
Voltage measurement mode is “2LL+Uo”.
Injection:
Ua = U12 = 100V ∠0°
Ub = U23 = 100/√ 3V ∠–150° = 57.7V ∠–150°
U 2
100 ∠0°
1 = 1 = --------- 1 ∠0° – 1 ⁄ 3 ∠+ 90° =
--- 1 a 100
3 2 100 ⁄ 3 ∠– 150° 3
U
2 1 a 1 ∠0° – 1 ⁄ 3 ∠– 30 °
U1 = 38.5%
U2 = 19.2%
U2/U1 = 50%
Figure 112 shows a geometric solution. The input values have been scaled with
√ 3/100 to make the calculation easier.
1
√3 U12-a2U23
2
120° -a U23
U12 U12
1 150° 120°
Negative sequence
U23 U23 aU23
-aU23 U12-aU23
1 1
√3 U12
U2 = 1/3
U1 =100/√ 3 x 2/3=38.5%
U2 = 100/√ 3 x 1/3 = 19.2%
U2/U1 = 1/3:2/3 = 50%
UN = 100V
Voltage measurement mode is “3LN”.
Injection:
Ua = UL1 = 100/√ 3V ∠0° = 57.7V ∠0°
Ub = UL2 = 100/√ 3V ∠− 120° = 57.7V ∠− 120°
Uc = UL3 = 0V
An identical case with Example 2. The resulting line-to-line voltages
U12=UL1 – UL2=100V ∠30° and U23= UL2 – UL3 =UL2=100/√ 3V∠120°
are the same. The only difference is a 30° phase angle difference, but without
any absolute angle reference the device does not see this phase angle difference.
100
U 1 1 1 --------- ∠0°
0 3 100 ∠0° + 100 ∠– 120°
1 1
U = --- 1 a a 2 100 = ---------- 100 ∠0° + 100 ∠0° =
1 3 --------- ∠– 120° 3 3
U 2 3 100 ∠0° + 100 ∠+120°
2 1 a a
0
U0 = 19.2%
U1 = 38.5%
U2 = 19.2%
U2/U1 = 50%
Figure 113 shows a graphical solution. The input values have been scaled with
√ 3/100 to make the calculation easier.
U1 = 2/3
2
a UL2
UL1+aUL2
Injected line-to-line voltages
UL2 UL2
UL1
U2 = 1/3
Primary, Secondary, and Per Many measurement values are shown as primary values although the 857 is
connected to secondary signals. Some measurement values are shown as
Unit Scaling relative values – per unit or percent. Almost all pick-up setting values are using
relative scaling. The scaling is done using the given CT, VT in feeder mode and
motor nameplate values in motor mode.
For scaling equations that are useful when doing secondary testing see:
• Current Scaling on page 227
• Per Unit [pu] Scaling of Line-to-Line Voltages on page 230
• Primary, Secondary, and Per Unit Scaling on page 226
• Voltage Scaling on page 229
Current Scaling
TIP The current input, 5 A or 1 A rated value of the device, has no effect in the
scaling equations. It defines the measurement range and the Maximum
allowed continuous current. See Measuring the Circuitry on page 347 for
details.
CT PRI
Secondary Primary I PRI = I SEC • -----------------
CT SEC
CT SEC
Primary Secondary I SEC = I PRI • -----------------
CT PRI
For residual currents to inputs I01 or I02, use the corresponding CTPRI and
CTSEC values. For earth-fault stages that use I0Calc signals, use the phase
current CT values for CTPRI and CTSEC.
CT = 500/5
Current to the device input is 4 A.
Primary current is IPRI = 4 x 500/5 = 400 A.
Example 2 – Primary to Secondary
CT = 500/5
The device displays IPRI = 400 A
Injected current is ISEC = 400 x 5/500 = 4 A.
CT = 750/5
Current injected to the device inputs is 7 A.
Per unit current is
IPU = 7/5 = 1.4 pu= 140%
Example 2 – Secondary to per unit and Percent for Phase Currents in Motor Mode Excluding
ArcI>
CT = 750/5
IMOT = 525 A
Current injected to the device inputs is 7 A.
Per unit current is
IPU = 7 x 750/(5 x 525) = 2.00 pu= 2.00 x IMOT = 200%
CT = 750/5
The device setting is 2 pu= 200%.
Secondary current is
ISEC = 2 x 5= 10 A
Example 4 – Per unit and Percent to Secondary for Phase Currents in Motor Mode Excluding
ArcI>
CT = 750/5
IMOT = 525 A
The device setting is 2 x IMOT = 2 pu= 200%.
Secondary current is
ISEC = 2 x 5 x 525/750= 7 A
Input is I0Calc.
CT = 750/5
Currents that are injected to the device IL1 input are 0.5 A.
IL2 = IL3 = 0.
Per unit current is
IPU = 0.5/5= 0.1 pu= 10%
Input is I0Calc.
CT = 750/5
The device setting is 0.1 pu= 10%.
If IL2 = IL3 = 0, then secondary current to IL11 is
ISEC = 0.1 x 5 = 0.5 A
VT PRI VT
PRI-
Secondary Primary U PRI = U SEC • ----------------- U PRI = 3 • U SEC • -------------------
VT SEC VT SEC
VT = 12000/110
Voltage that is connected to the device input Ua or Ub is 100V.
Primary voltage is upRI = 100 x 12000/110 = 10909V
Example 2 – Secondary to Primary. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “3LN”
VT = 12000/110
Three-phase symmetric voltages that are connected to the device inputs Ua, Ub
and Uc are 57.7V.
Primary voltage is upRI = √ 3 x 58 x 12000/110 = 10902V
VT = 12000/110
The device displays upRI = 10910V.
Secondary voltage is USEC = 10910 x 110/12000 = 100V
Example 4 – Primary to Secondary. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “3LN”
VT = 12000/110
The device displays U12 = U23 = U31 = 10910V.
Symmetric secondary voltages at Ua, Ub, and Uc are
USEC = 10910/√ 3 x 110/12000 = 57.7 V4
VT = 12000/110
Voltage that is connected to the device input Ua or Ub is 110V.
Per unit voltage is
upU = 110/110 = 1.00 pu= 1.00 x UN = 100%
VT = 12000/110
Three symmetric phase-to-neutral voltages that are connected to the device
inputs Ua,Ub and Uc are 63.5V
Per unit voltage is
upU = √ 3 x 63.5 /110 x 12000 /11000 = 1.00 pu = 1.00 x UN = 100%
VT = 12000/110
The device displays 1.00 pu= 100%.
Secondary voltage is
USEC = 1.00 x 110 x 11000/12000 = 100.8V
VT = 12,000/110
UN = 11,000V
The device displays 1.00 pu= 100%.
Three symmetric phase-to-neutral voltages that are connected to the
device inputs Ua, Ub and Uc are
USEC = 1.00 x 110/√3 x 11000/12000 = 58.2V
Secondary
U SEC 1 Ua + Ub + Uc
Per unit
UPU = --------------- U PU = ---------------- • -----------------------------------
U 0SEC VTSEC 3
Per unit
Secondary U SEC = U PU • U 0SEC U a + U b + U c
SEC
= 3 • U PU • VT SEC
VT = 12000/110
Voltage that is connected to the device input Ua is 66V, while
Ua = Ub = 0.
Per unit voltage is
upU = (66+0+0)/(3x110) = 0.20 pu= 20%
VT = 12000/110
The device displays U0 = 20%.
If Ub = Uc = 0, then secondary voltages at Ua are
USEC = √3 x 0.2 x 3 x 110 = 38.1V
Notes:
Control Functions
Output Relays Output relays are also called digital outputs. Any internal signal can be logically
connected to the output relays by using output matrix. An output relay can be
configured as latched or non-latched. See Output Matrix on page 236 for more
details.
The difference between trip contacts and alarm contacts is the DC break
capacity. See Table 173 on page 349 and Table 174 on page 349 for details. The
contacts are SPST, except alarm relays A1 and A5, which have change over
contacts (SPDT). T1…T14 and A1…A5 can be configured for N.O. or N.C.
polarity through the front panel or SetPointPS.
Digital Inputs There are up to 32 digital inputs available for control purposes (varies by
model). The polarity – normal open (N.O.) / normal closed (N.C.) – and a
delay can be configured according to the application. The signals are available
for the output matrix, block matrix, programmable logic, and so on. When
120V or 220V AC is used to activate the digital input. Use the SetPointPS
software to select the AC Mode.
The contacts that are connected to digital inputs DI1…DI6 must be dry. These
inputs use the common internal 48-Vdc wetting-voltage from terminal X3:1,
only.
TIP Do not connect Digital inputs DI1… DI6 parallel with inputs of another
device.
Label and description texts can be edited with SetPointPS according to the
application. Labels are the short parameter names that are used on the local
panel and descriptions are the longer names that are used by SetPointPS.
The digital input signals can be used for blocking and control signals for the
output relays. An additional input card is available as an option. The additional
option card is in the X8 location and has the same ratings as the card in X7.
Table 115 - Digital Input Threshold Voltages
Common Input group Wetting-voltage
input
On Off
X7:7 X7: 1…6 (DI 7…12) ≥18V DC or ≥50V AC ≤ 10V DC or ≤ 5V AC
X7:14 X7: 8…13 (DI ≥18V DC or ≥50V AC ≤ 10 Vdc or ≤ 5V AC
13…18)
Virtual Inputs and Outputs There are four virtual inputs and six virtual outputs. The four virtual inputs act
like normal digital inputs. The state of the virtual input can be changed from
the display, through a communication bus and from SetPointPS. The setting of
groups can be done using virtual inputs. The polarity (V=value) can be
configured, according to the application use, using the SetPointPS tool.
The six virtual outputs act like output relays, but there are no physical contacts.
Virtual outputs are shown in the output matrix and the block matrix. Virtual
outputs can be used with the programmable logic and to change the active
setting group, and so on. Virtual inputs and outputs can be used to start and
stop an application remotely. They can also be used for condition or switching
device status feedback, or to open, or close, the main switching device such as a
contactor or circuit breaker.
Output Matrix The output matrix connects, the output signals of the various protection stages,
digital inputs, and logic outputs. The output matrix also connects to other
internal signals to the output relays, front-panel status indicators, virtual
outputs, and so on.
There are two status indicators named ‘Alarm’” and ‘Trip’ on the front panel.
There are three general-purpose status indicators – ‘A’, ‘B’, and ‘C’ – available
for customer-specific indications. In addition, the triggering of the disturbance
recorder (DR) and virtual outputs are configurable in the output matrix. See an
example in Figure 114.
There is a common “release latched” signal to release all latched relays. This
release signal resets all latched output relays and indicators. Use a digital input,
a keypad, or by communication.to give the reset signal. Any digital input can be
used for resetting. The selection of the input is done with the SetPointPS
software under the menu ‘Release output matrix latches’. Under the same
menu, the ‘Release latches’ parameter can be used for resetting. The enter key
releases the latches from the front panel.
Block Matrix With a block matrix, the operation of any protection stage can be blocked. The
blocking signal can:
• Originate from the digital inputs DI1 to DIn (see chapter order
code).
• Be a start or trip signal from a protection stage.
• Be an output signal from the programmable logic.
In the block matrix (Figure 115), active blocking is indicated with a black dot
(•) in the crossing point of a blocking signal and the signal to be blocked.
Stage 1
Start
Trip
Block
Stage 2
Start
Trip
Block
Digital Inputs
Controllable Objects The relay allows controlling of six objects, that is, circuit-breakers,
disconnectors and earthing switches. Control is done using the “select-execute”
or “direct control” principle.
The logic functions can configure interlocking for controlling before the
output pulse is issued. Objects 1…6 are controllable while objects 7…8 are only
able to show the status. Control is possible through:
• The local HMI.
• Remote communication.
• Digital input.
Object States
Each object has the states shown in Table 117.
Each controllable object has the settings shown in the following table.
If a state change exceeds the “Max ctrl pulse length” setting, the object fails and
the “Object failure” matrix signal is set. Also an undefined-event is generated.
“Completion timeout” is only used for the ready indication. If “DI for ‘obj
ready’” is not set, completion timeout has no meaning.
When digital input, remote bus, auto-reclose (and so forth) control an object,
these signals send a control pulse.
Each read-only object has the settings shown in the following table.
If a state change takes longer than the time defined by the “Object timeout”
setting, the object fails and an“Object failure” matrix signal is set. Also
undefined-event is generated.
Controlling with DI
Objects can be controlled with digital input, virtual input, or virtual output.
There are four settings for each controllable object.
If the device is in local control state, the remote control inputs are ignored and
vice versa. Object is controlled when a rising edge is detected from the selected
input. The length of a digital input pulse is at least 60 ms.
Local/Remote Selection
In Local mode, the output relays can be controlled through a local HMI. Also a
serial communication interface cannot control the output relays remotely.
In Remote mode, the output relays cannot be controlled though a local HMI,
but a serial communication interface can control them remotely.
Auto-reclose Function (79) The 857 Protection System protection relays include a sophisticated Auto-
reclosing (AR) function. The AR function is normally used in feeder
protection relays that helps protect an overhead line. Most overhead line faults
are temporary. An estimated 85% can be cleared by using the AR function.
General
Normal protection functions detect the fault. The protection function then
triggers the AR function. After tripping the circuit-breaker (CB) or contactor,
the AR function can reclose the CB or contactor. Normally, the first reclose (or
shot) is so short in time that consumers cannot notice anything. However, the
fault is cleared and the feeder continues in normal service.
Terminology
There are five reclose shots. A shot consists of open time (so called “dead” time)
and close time (so called “burning” time or discrimination time). A high-speed
shot means that the dead time is less than 1 s. The time-delayed shot means
longer dead times up to 2…3 minutes.
There are four AR lines. A line means an initialization signal for AR. Normally,
start or trip signals of protection functions are used to initiate an AR-sequence.
Each AR line has a priority. AR1 has the highest and AR4 has the lowest one. If
two lines are initiated simultaneously, AR follows only the highest priority
line. A typical configuration of the lines is that the instantaneous overcurrent
stage initiates the AR1 line, time-delayed overcurrent stage the AR2 line, and
earth-fault-protection uses lines AR3 and AR4.
The auto-reclose (AR) matrix in Figure 116 describes the start and trip signals
that are forwarded to the auto-reclose function.
Open CB
Dead time Discrimination time Reclaim time
Open CB
.
.
I>>s
I>t
I>s
Critical 0…300 s 0…300 s
Shot 1 AR1 In use
AR2 In use 0…300 s 0…300 s 0…300 s 0…300 s
shot
time, continue on the next
activated during reclaim
If new AR request is
make final trip
during discrimination time,
If critical signal is activated
Shot 3…5
The AR matrix (Figure 116) defines which signals (the start and trip signals
from protection stages or digital input) are forwarded to the auto-reclose
function. In the AR function, the AR signals can be configured to initiate the
reclose sequence. Each shot from 1…5 has its own enabled/disabled flag. If
multiple AR signals activate simultaneously, AR1 has highest priority and AR2
the lowest. Each AR signal has an independent start delay for the shot 1. If a
higher priority AR signal activates during the start delay, the start delay setting
is changed to that of the highest priority AR signal.
After the start delay, the circuit-breaker (CB) opens. When the CB opens, a
dead time timer is started. Each shot from 1…5 has its own dead time setting.
After the dead time, the CB closes and a discrimination time timer is started.
Each shot from 1…5 has its own discrimination time setting. If a critical signal
is activated during the discrimination time, the AR function makes a final trip.
The CB opens and the AR sequence is locked. The CB manually clears the
“locked” state when it is closed
After the discrimination time has elapsed, the reclaim time timer starts. If any
AR signal is activated during the reclaim time or the discrimination time, the
AR function moves to the next shot. The reclaim time setting is common for
every shot.
If the reclaim time expires, the auto-reclose sequence is successfully executed and
the AR function moves to ready-state and waits for a new AR request in shot 1.
A trip signal from the protection stage can be used as a backup. Configure the
start signal of the protection stage to initiate the AR function. If something
fails in the AR function, the trip signal of the protection stage opens the CB.
The delay setting for the protection stage must be longer than the AR start
delay and discrimination time.
Manual Closing
When a CB is closed manually, for example with the local panel, remote bus,
digital inputs, the reclaim state is activated. Within the reclaim time, all AR
requests are ignored. It is up to the protection stages to take care of tripping.
Trip signals of the protection stages must be connected to a trip relay in the
output matrix.
Manual Opening
Blocking of AR Shots
Each AR shot can be blocked with a digital input, virtual input, or virtual
output. The blocking input, is selected with Block setting. When selected
input is active, the shot is blocked. A blocked shot is treated like it does not
exist and AR sequence jumps over it. If the last shot in use is blocked, any AR
request during the reclaiming of the previous shot causes a final trip.
Starting AR Sequence
Each AR request has a separate counter for the starting delay. The one where
the starting delay has elapsed first, is selected. If multiple delays elapse
simultaneously, an AR request of the highest priority is selected. AR1 has the
highest priority and AR4 has the lowest priority. First shot is selected
according to the AR request. Next AR opens the CB and starts counting dead
time.
Each AR request line can be enabled to any combination of the five shots. For
example, a sequence of Shot 2 and Shot 4 for AR request 1 is done by enabling
AR1 only for those two shots.
TIP If AR sequence is started at shot 2…5, the starting delay is taken from the
discrimination time setting of the previous shot. For example, if Shot 3 is the
first shot for AR2, Discrimination time of Shot 2 for AR2 defines the starting
delay for the sequence.
Critical AR Request
Critical AR request stops the AR sequence and causes final tripping. Critical
request is ignored when AR sequence is not running and when AR is
reclaiming. Critical signal is accepted only during dead time and
discrimination time.
When a starting delay has elapsed, active signal of the first shot is set. If
successful reclosing is executed at the end of the shot, the active signal is reset
after reclaim time. If reclosing was not successful or new fault appears during
reclaim time, the active of the current shot is reset. Then the active signal of the
next shot is set (if any shots remain before final trip).
This signal indicates dead time. The signal is set after controlling CB open.
When dead time ends, the signal is reset and CB is controlled close.
There are five final trip signals in the matrix, one for each AR request (1…4 and
critical). When final trip is generated, one of these signals is set according to
the AR request, which caused the final tripping. The final trip signal stays
active for 0.5 seconds and then resets automatically.
When AR info is enabled, the local panel mimic display shows a small info box
during AR sequence.
Table 122 - Setting Parameters
Parameter Value Unit Default Description
ARena ARon; ARoff - ARon Enabling/disabling the Auto reclose.
Block None - - The digital input for block information, can be
Any digital input, used, for example, for Synchrocheck.
virtual input, or
virtual output
AR_DI None - - The digital input for toggling the ARena
Any digital input, parameter.
virtual input, or
virtual output
AR2grp ARon; ARoff - ARon Enabling/disabling the Auto reclose for group 2.
ReclT 0.02…300.00 s 10.00 Reclaim time setting. Common for all shots.
ARreq On - Off AR request event.
Off
ShotS On - Off AR shot start event.
Off
ARlock On - Off AR locked event
Off
CritAr On - Off AR critical signal event.
Off
Discrimination
Discrimination
Reclaim Time
Start Delay1
Dead Time1
Dead Time2
two shots. After shot 2
the fault is cleared.
Time1
time2
I> setting
Current
Open CB
Close CB
CB close state
CB open state
1. Current exceeds the I> setting; the start delay from shot 1 starts.
2. After the start delay, an OpenCB relay output closes.
3. A CB opens. The dead time from shot 1 starts, and the OpenCB relay
output opens.
4. The dead time from shot 1 expires; a CloseCB output relay closes.
5. The CB closes. The CloseCB output relay opens, and the discrimination
time from shot 1 starts. The current is still over the I> setting.
6. The discrimination time from the shot 1 expires; the OpenCB relay
output closes.
7. The CB opens. The dead time from shot 2 starts, and the OpenCB relay
output opens.
8. The dead time from shot 2 expires; the CloseCB output relay closes.
9. The CB closes. The CloseCB output relay opens, and the discrimination
time from shot 2 starts. The current is now under I> setting.
10. Reclaim time starts. After the reclaim time, the AR sequence is
successfully executed. The AR function moves to wait for a new AR
request in shot 1.
Logic Functions The device supports customer-defined programmable logic for Boolean signals
with the same functionality as DeviceLogix™. However, this implementation is
not in the same format as DeviceLogix™ and is not configurable other than
through SetPointPS.
The logic is designed by using the SetPointPS setting tool and downloaded to
the device. Functions available are:
• NOT
• COUNTERs
• RS and D flip-flops
• AND
• OR
• XOR
The maximum number of outputs is 20, and the maximum number of input
gates is 31. An input gate can include any number of inputs.
See Figure 119 …Figure 121 that illustrate the basics of logic creation.
1. Left click any logic function to activate the “Select operation” view.
2. Edit properties button opens the “Function properties” window.
3. It is possible to choose the type of logic function required. The pull-
down option window displays all available logic functions available.
4. When a counter element is selected, counter-setting must be set.
5. Separate Time ON (TON) and Time OFF (TOF) delay setting for
logic activation and deactivation.
6. It can be possible to invert the output of logic. Any inverted logic output
is marked with a small circle at the output.
1. To select the input signals for a logic element, click the “1”button. Or
left click the logic input line.
2. To select the outputs for a logic element, click the “2” button. Or left
click the logic output line.
3. To delete the logic function, click the button “1”.
4. When logic is created and settings are written to the IED, the unit
requires a restart. After restarting the logic, output is automatically
assigned in Output Matrix.
IMPORTANT SetPointPS software requires a unit restart whenever new logic is written to
the 857.
Communications
Communication Ports The relay has the option of having multiple communication ports. An
additional Ethernet port is available as an option. When this option is chosen,
it takes over the option 2 slot.
There can be up to three ports in the rear panel. The front panel RS-232 port
shuts off the local port on the rear panel when a programming cable
(857-VX003-3) is inserted.
Communication
Option 1
Front panel in use
X9
Communication
RS-232 Option 2
GND
X10
DTR out
Tx out
Rx in Ethernet
D9S
DSR in X10
Local Port
TIP The local port functionality can be available through connector X9 or X10,
depending on the type of communication modules and DIP switch settings
(see Chapter 9).
TIP When the programming cable (857-VX003-3) is inserted to the front panel
connector, it activates the front panel port. This action disables the rear-
panel local port by connecting the DTR pin 6 and DSR pin 4 together. See
Figure 122.
The front panel port uses the command-line protocol for SetPointPS,
regardless of the selected protocol for the rear-panel local port.
If a protocol other than “None” is selected for the rear-panel local port.
The front panel connector continues using the plain command-line interface
with the original speed, parity, and so on, when selected.
For example, if the rear-panel local port is used for remote SetPointPS
communication using SPA-bus default 9600/7E1. It is possible to connect a
personal computer, temporarily, with SetPointPS to the front panel connector
with the default 38400/8N1. While the front panel connector is in use, the
rear-panel local port is disabled. The communication parameter display on the
local display shows the active parameter values for the local port.
Physical Interface
The physical standard of this port is RS-232. The physical connector depends
on the option module selected.
speed/DPS s.
Default = 38400/ D = number of Data bits
8N1 for SetPointPS P = parity: none, even, odd
S = number of stop bits
SetPointPS Communication (Direct or SPA-bus embedded command-line interface)
Tx bytes/size Unsent bytes in transmitter buffer/size of the buffer
Msg# 0…232–1 Message counter since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
Errors 0…216–1 Errors since the device has restarted or since last clearing C(2)
Tout 0…216–1 Timeout errors since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).
(2) C = Clearing to zero is possible.
(3) The Communication parameters are set in the protocol-specific menus. For the local port command-line interface, the
parameters are set in configuration menu.
Remote Port X9
Physical Interface
The physical interface of this port depends on the communication letter in the
order code. See Figure 122 and Table 125. The TTL interface is for external
converters and converter cables only. It is not suitable for direct connection in
excess of 1 meter.
Table 125 - Physical Interface and Connector Types of Remote Port X5 with Various Options.
TTL (A) Is the Default
Order Code Communication Interface Connector Type
A TTL (for external converters only) D9S
B Plastic fiber interface HFBR-0500
C Not available –
D RS-485 (isolated) Screw crimp
Table 125 - Physical Interface and Connector Types of Remote Port X5 with Various Options.
TTL (A) Is the Default (Continued)
Order Code Communication Interface Connector Type
E Glass fiber interface (62.5/125 μm) (For 857-RAD) SMA
F Plastic Rx/glass (62.5/125 μm) Tx fiber interface HFBR-0500/SMA
G Glass (62.5/125 μm) Rx/plastic fiber interface SMA/HFBR-0500
I RJ45 (RS-232) –
M Dual ST 100-Mbps fiber Ethernet SMA
N Single glass fiber interface (62.5/125 μm) for 857-RAA SMA
Extension Port
The 857 supports two Ethernet protocols that run simultaneously on the same
physical port. These settings are defined in Ethernet Protocol 1and 2. For each
protocol, an IP (logical) port number is required. The default port numbers in
the relay are 44818 for EtherNet/IP, 102 for 61850 and 102 for Modbus TCP.
Other protocols require an alternate port number to be set.
The Protocol Configuration Menu contains the address and other related
information for the Ethernet port. TCP port 1st and 2nd instance include
selection for the protocol, IP port settings, message, error, and timeout
counters. See Table 128 for more information.
Table 128 - Main Configuration Parameters (Local Display), Built in Ethernet Port
Parameter Value Description Note
Protocol Protocol selection for the extension port Set(3)
None Command-line interface for SetPointPS
ModbusTCPs Modbus TCP slave
IEC-101 IEC-101
IEC 61850 IEC-61850 protocol(2)
EtherNet/IP EtherNet/IP protocol
DNP3 DNP/TCP
Port nnn Ip port for protocol, default 502 Set(3)
Table 128 - Main Configuration Parameters (Local Display), Built in Ethernet Port (Continued)
Parameter Value Description Note
IpAddr n.n.n.n Internet Protocol address Set(3)
(set with SetPointPS)
NetMsk n.n.n.n Net mask (set with SetPointPS) Set(3)
Gatew Default = 0.0.0.0 Gateway IP Address Set(3)
(set with SetPointPS)
NTPSvr n.n.n.n Network-time protocol server Set(3)
(set with SetPointPS) 0.0.0.0 = no SNTP
KeepAlive(1) nn TCP keep alive interval Set(3)
FTP server on/off Enable FTP server (click to turn on) Set(3)
FTP speed 4 Kb/s (default) Maximum transmission speed for FTP Set(3)
FTP password ? = User Mode FTP password Set(3)
Config =configurator
mode
MAC address 001D9CF23B40 through Media Access Control Address —
001D9CF2433F
IP Port for Nn IP port for SetPointPS Set(3)
setting tool 23 (default)
Msg# nnn Message counter —
Errors nnn Error counter —
Tout nnn Timeout counter —
EthSffEn on/off Sniffer port enabled Set(3)
SniffPort Port2 Sniffer port —
(1) The KeepAlive parameter sets the time between two keep alive packets that are sent from the 857 (in seconds). The setting
range for this parameter is 1…20 seconds. A set long duration time can be set by entering zero. The zero entry defines a
120 seconds (2 minutes) time. The purpose of a Keep Alive packet is for the 857 to send a probe packet to a connected client. It
checks the status of the TCP-connection when no other packet is being sent, for example client does not poll Data from the 857.
If the Keep Alive packet is not acknowledged, the 857 closes the TCP connection. Connection must be resumed on the client side.
(2) The IEC 61850 protocol must be specified at the time of order placement. A relay with the standard Ethernet option does not
support IEC 61850.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).
Communication Protocols These protocols enable the transfer of this type of data:
• Events
• Status information
• Measurements
• Control Commands
• Clock synchronizing
• Settings (SPA-bus and embedded SPA-bus only)
These Modbus protocols are often used in power plants and in industrial
applications. The difference between these two protocols is the media.
Modbus TCP uses Ethernet and Modbus RTU uses asynchronous
communication (RS-485, optic fiber, RS-232).
SetPointPS shows the list of all available data items for Modbus. See page 459
for a list of Modbus parameters.
IMPORTANT To configure an 857 Protection System, the SetPointPS relay setting and
configuration tool is needed (obtain SetPointPS from
www.rockwellautomation.com).
In the master-slave setup of Modbus, only the master can initiate transactions
(queries). The slaves respond by supplying the requested data to the master, or
by the action that is requested in the query. The master can address individual
slaves, or initiate a broadcast message to all slaves. The address space for slaves
in Modbus RTU ranges from 1…247 on one data link. Address 0 is reserved for
broadcast.
To check the mapping of particular data items to the holding registers in 857
Protection Systems, use SetPointPS. Select the items below the Modbus Main
Configuration (see Figure 125). See page 459 for Modbus mappings.
TIP The data mappings are not visible if the Modbus protocol is not activated.
See See Configuration on page 263 for instructions how to activate the
protocol.
The values in the Address column (ex. “40xxxx”) consist of two parts: “40”
and “xxxx”. The prefix “40” denotes a reference to Read/Write Output or
Holding Registers. The “xxxx” denotes the address of a particular register.
The bit rate of Modbus RTU is typically 9600 bps and for the transmission of
frames, a parity check mode must be selected (even, odd, or none parity
checking).
Figure 125 - Modbus Data Mappings in SetPointPS (from 857 Protection System)
The Modbus RTU and Modbus TCP protocols in 857 Protection System can
transfer these types of data:
• Events
• Status information
• Measurements
• Control commands
• Clock synchronization
Configuration
This section describes how to configure an 857 Protection System to use the
Modbus RTU protocol.
TIP The configuration and features vary between simultaneously 857 Protection
System models, such as what scaling settings there are and what data is
available in the holding registers.
General
The Modbus RTU protocol is activated by setting it as the Port protocol for a
serial port on the relay at hand. This setting can be found by navigating to the
Protocol Configuration List in SetPointPS. See Figure 126, Figure 127, and
Figure 128 for a series of graphics to illustrate the enabling of the Modbus
protocol on the Remote port of a relay.
Figure 126 - Protocol Selection for the Remote Port without Any Protocol Selected
Figure 127 - Protocol Selection Box Visible for the Remote Port. ModBusSlv (Modbus as Slave)
Highlighted
The protocol is enabled through the local panel of an 857 Protection System
(enter the password for the configurator access level).
IMPORTANT To set a relay to function as a Modbus RTU Slave: select the protocol that is
called “ModbusSlv” in SetPointPS and on the Bus-menu of the local display
of the relay.
Restart the relay for a communication protocol change, for any port, to take
effect.
The holding register address, which is sent though Modbus, is one less than
that indicated by an 857 Protection System. For example, if the Alive
Indicator, with the holding register address 2001 (see Figure 125), is sent
over a Modbus data link. The frame indicates that the address of the holding
register is 2000.
In the Modbus main configuration, you can view the Modbus Slave Address
(or number), and the bit rate. You can also set the parity of the connection
(highlighted as “Editable fields” in Figure 129).
IMPORTANT The parity and bit rate must be set to the same value on all devices that are
connected to the same data link.
Clock Synchronization
The clock can be synchronized (all fields: seconds, minutes, hours, days,
month, and year) or by synchronizing only the minutes, which in turn sets the
seconds and milliseconds to zero.
EXAMPLE For minute synchronization, when the reference clock is 7 minutes past (any
hour), a minute synchronization is performed. The result is that the internal
clock, of the relay, is set to HH: 07:00.000 (“Hours: Minutes: Seconds:
Milliseconds”) “HH” does not change. As a recommendation, perform time
synchronization hourly.
These two ways to synchronize the clock, “Set RTC”, where “RTC” represents
“Real-Time Clock” and “Synchronize Minutes” in the data map. The holding
register address of the minute synchronization is 2502. See Table 133 for the
holding registers allocated to the Set RTC synchronization.
Events
Use the Modbus RTU Protocol to read the event buffer of an 857 Protection
System, one event at a time, from the holding registers 2101…2105. The event
registers contain the latest event, and are cleared when they are read. The
registers are then updated to contain the following event from the event buffer.
A description of the registers is shown in Table 134.
If an error occurs when reading an event from registers 2101…2105, then the
previously read event is available registers 2490…2494 for re-reading.
Events are coded with a numbering starting from 0…8900 (software version
Rockwell Automation® 12.001. New features are added to software that create
event codes. For the meaning of event codes, contact Rockwell Automation or
run the GETSET-command “to get event codes” in the SetPointPS Terminal.
To start type “Ctrl + T”.
Scaling
The holding registers are 16 bits. They can directly represent 216 = 65535
simultaneously values, which are not enough to describe the values of some
physical quantity such as voltage or power. Therefore, values that are
transmitted over a Modbus data link must be scaled.
The equation of the line where two points are connected in a two-dimensional
space (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) determines the scaling. That is, the trajectory of the
line and the offset from origin (Figure 130).
IMPORTANT There is no offset in the example if the point (x1, y1) is assumed to lie at the
origin.
It is common to use a scale factor with base ten (10, 100, 1000…) since, in such
cases, the original measurements only lose decimals. The values are easy to read
and rescale to actual values on the client side after transmission.
Settings for scaling can be used for the power-, power factor-, tan phi-,
voltage-, and frequency scaling. Settings can be done by navigating to the
MODBUS & PROFIBUS: SCALINGS item in the Group List in SetPointPS
(see Figure 132.
A short example: The frequency is internally (in the relay) stored as an integer
value, which also holds three decimal places, that is, 50.000 Hz is represented as
50000. A value too large to be represented with 16 bits (signed integer). By
default, frequency is scaled with the points: (x1, y1) = (0, 0) and (x2, y2) = (10,
1) (see Figure 131 and Figure 132), so it to be sent over Modbus.
y2 – y1 1–0
The slope is: ----------------
- = --------------- = 0.1 and there is no offset.
x2 – x1 10 – 0
Thus, the value on the receiving side (the Modbus value) is:
To make sure that a scaling has been set as intended, it can be checked in
SetPointPS by viewing the Scaling column for each holding register in the
MODBUS SLAVE: 40xxxx-> items in the Group List in SetPointPS, see
Figure 133.
An example is shown in Figure 134, which shows the voltage scaling changed
(x2 changed to 10 from 1). Figure 135, shows the meaning of the scaling for
some affected and non-affected holding registers. Compare the value of the
scaling for the holding registers that use Voltage scaling in Figure 133.
IMPORTANT It is highly recommended to scale values so that they are kept in the interval
0…32768 to avoid overflow.
Figure 133 - Meaning of the Default Scaling for Some Holding Registers
Modbus TCP
IMPORTANT Default port for Modbus TCP is 502. There are cases where it can change
depending on the device that is used to poll it.
Configuration
IMPORTANT 857 Protection Systems do not support DHCP, Dynamic Host Configuration
Protocol, and require a static IP address to be configured
IMPORTANT There are two TCP port instances “TCP PORT first INST” and “TCP PORT second
INST”, that is, two independent sockets for two simultaneously protocols.
The default TCP/IP port for Modbus TCP is 502.
When these settings are configured, one of the TCP PORT Ethernet port
protocol selections can be set to “ModbusTCPs” (Modbus TCP, slave), see
Figure 136.
Before the protocol is activated, SetPointPS prompts for a device restart when
any of the settings, mentioned earlier, are changed.
Data access can be done by using SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol).
SNTP is used for reading and writing to the holding registers, event reading,
clock synchronization, and scaling work as described in the previous sections,
with the addition that clock synchronization. An NTP server is required with
the address set in the Ethernet Port setting-section of the Protocol
Configuration view in SetPointPS, see Figure 136.
IP port selection
This section gives examples of how to test that the Modbus protocol (Modbus
RTU or Modbus TCP) is successfully configured using the 857 Protection
System protocol test tool, Simple Tester.
Simple Tester is a basic protocol tool for testing (for Personal Computer) that
supports several protocols, including Modbus RTU and TCP. Simple Tester
can be used to test reading data from the holding registers, writing to the
holding registers, event viewing, and clock synchronization from the personal
computer. The user interface of Simple Tester with Modbus selected as
protocol (but not connected to a relay) is shown and explained in Figure 137.
Simple Tester can be requested from Rockwell Automation® as required.
Figure 137 - User Interface of Simple Tester with Modbus Selected as Protocol
Communication
parameters (protocol
selection and device
connection configuration
Connection Status
To connect a relay with Modbus RTU, the device must first be configured as
described in Configuration on page 263. A physical connection must be made
to the relay. As the physical connection varies depending on the relay models
and selection of serial ports to be used, the making of the physical connection is
not described in this section.
When a physical connection has been made, Simple Tester can be connected to
the relay with these steps:
To connect a relay with Modbus TCP, the device Ethernet port and TCP port
instances must be configured as described in Modbus TCP on page 270. An
Ethernet connection (physical) to the relay from the personal computer that is
running Simple Tester must be made.
Read Data
To read Data, follow these steps (for reference see Figure 6 or Figure 138):
Figure 139 features an example of reading the Alive Counter (HR 2001)
cyclically every 3 seconds.
Figure 139 - Performing a Cyclic Read on the Alive Counter with Simple Tester
Write Data
Figure 140 features an example of the value 1 to Virtual Input 1 (the holding
register 3427).
The Event view of Simple Tester now contains an event, which corresponds to
“Virtual Input 1 ON”.
If there are events in the event buffer when Simple Tester is connected, they are
listed in the event view. Writes that are done with Simple Tester trigger new
events that also show up.
A clock synchronization can be performed with Simple Tester. Set the desired
behavior in the Time Controls (Figure 137).
The two leftmost fields are used for setting the time manually. The time can be
taken from the personal computer, by checking the Time checkbox in Simple
Tester.
PROFIBUS DP
Use the request mode to read all available data from the 857 device and still use
only a short buffer for PROFIBUS data transfer. The drawback is slower data
transfer and increased data that is processed at the PROFIBUS master. The
master requests every data item separately.
TIP In request mode, it is not possible to read continuously — only one single
data item. At least two data items must be read in turn to get updated data
from the device.
Available Data
SetPointPS shows the list of all available data items for both modes.
SPA-Bus
The 857 relay has full support for the SPA-bus protocol including reading and
writing the setting values. Reading multiple (or consecutive) status data bits,
measurement values, or setting values with one message is supported.
IEC 60870-5-103
The IEC standard 60870-5-103 “Companion standard for the informative
interface of protection equipment” provides standardized communication
interface to a primary system (master system).
The unbalanced transmission mode of the protocol is used, and the device
functions as a secondary station (slave) in the communication. Data is
transferred to the primary system by using “data acquisition by polling”
principle. The IEC functionality includes these application functions:
• Station initialization
• General interrogation
• Clock synchronization and
• Command transmission
Parameter data or disturbance recordings cannot transfer through the IEC 103
protocol interface.
Application Service Data Unit (ASDU) types are used in communication from
the device are:
• ASDU 1: time tagged message
• ASDU 3: Measurands I
• ASDU 5: Identification message
• ASDU 6: Time synchronization and
• ASDU 8: Termination of general interrogation
These identifications are fixed for data items in the compatible range of the
protocol. For example, the trip of I> function has: type identification = 1,
function type = 160 and information number = 90. “Private range” function
types are used for data items that are undefined by the standard. For example,
the status of the digital inputs and the control of the objects.
The function type and information number that is used in private range
messages is configurable to enable flexible interfacing to simultaneously master
systems. For more information on IEC 60870-5-103 in the 857 Protection
System, contact Rockwell Automation.
DNP 3.0
IEC 60870-5-101
The IEC 60870-5-101 standard is derived from the IEC 60870-5 protocol
standard definition. In 857 devices, IEC 60870-5-101 communication
protocol is available through menu selection. The 857 relay works as a
controlled outstation (slave) unit in unbalanced mode.
For more information on IEC 60870-5-101 with the 857, contact Rockwell
Automation.
External Modbus I/O devices can be connected to the device uses this
protocol. See External Input/Output Modules on page 338 for more
information.
IEC 61850
EtherNet/IP
File Transfer Protocol (FTP) The FTP server is available on the 857 devices that are equipped with a built-in
or optional Ethernet card.
Server
The FTP server is used to pull these files from an 857:
• Disturbance recordings.
• The MasterICD and MasterICDEd2 files.
• Use the 857 HMI by navigating to Bus, Ethernet Port, FTP server, and
setting the value to “On”.
Figure 141 - Configuration of the FTP Server in SetPointPS Version 2.2.134 or Higher.
IMPORTANT For information about how to log in with SetPointPS version 2.2.134 or
higher, publication 857-PM001.
(1) In all of these cases, a 0, 1login with configurator access level is required.
To log in use the Terminal routines in SetPointPS and with the 857, follow
these Terminal steps (Bold text indicates user entered data).
The MasterICD and MasterICDEd2 files are specific reference files that can be
used for offline IEC61850 configuration. The built-in FTP client in Microsoft
Windows or any other compatible FTP client can be used to pull files from the
device.
Connect to the FTP Server Once the FTP server has been enabled and the Ethernet connection is
established between a personal computer and the 857, there are two options
Using Windows DOS for connecting to it: The FTP client through the command-line, and the FTP
client by Windows Explorer.
2
3
4
5
6
Figure 144 - Enter the IP Address Into the Address Field of Windows Explorer
4. Type user name “vamp” and password into the prompt. The default
password is “config”. See Figure 145.
5. Click “Log on”.
The files appear in the Explorer™ window.
6. Right-click on the desired file. Select “Copy” to copy the file to the
clipboard. See Figure 146.
The file can now be pasted to a desired directory on the personal
computer.
The 857 Protection System can be supplied with one Ethernet with a RJ45
port to connect Ethernet CAT5 or better cables or an optional dual fiber-optic
interface. Rockwell Automation offers a wide variety of Allen-Bradley®
Ethernet patch cables with its Bulletin 1585 line of Ethernet cables (http://
ab.rockwellautomation.com/Connection-Devices/RJ45-Network-Media).
The 857 Protection System supports a Star, Linear, and Ring Ethernet
topology. A Star Ethernet Topology is shown in Figure 147, where all Ethernet
nodes wire back to a central Ethernet switch, hub, or router.
857
Ethernet Switch
Fiber Fiber
Determine Network To operate an EtherNet/IP network, you must define these parameters.
Parameters Table 144 - EtherNet/IP Network Parameters
Network Parameter Description
IP Address The IP Address uniquely identifies the module. The IP Address is in the
form xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx where each xxx is a number from 0...255. Do not
use these IP Addresses, they are reserved values:
• 0.0.0.1…0.255.255.255
• 127.0.0.0…127.255.255.255
• 224.255.255.255…255.255.255.255
Subnet Mask Subnet addressing is an extension of the IP Address scheme that allows
a site to use one network ID for multiple physical networks. Routing
outside of the site continues by dividing the IP Address into a net ID and
a host ID by the class. Inside a site, the Subnet Mask is used to redivide
the IP Address into a custom network ID portion and host ID portion.
Important: If the Subnet Mask of a configured module is changed,
cycle power to the module for the change to take effect.
Gateway A gateway connects individual physical networks into a system of
networks. When a node is required to communicate with a node on
another network, a gateway transfers the data between the two
networks.
Set the Network IP Address The 857 Protection System is shipped with DHCP disabled. To set the
network Internet Protocol (IP) address, use the following tools and software:
• The SetPointPS Configuration Software Tool.
• A Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/Dynamic Host Configuration
Protocol (DHCP) server (for example, the Rockwell Automation®
BOOTP-DHCP Server Utility, which is included RSLinx® Classic
software).
• A web browser and MAC scanner software.
By default, the 857 has DHCP disabled. It can only be enabled by using the
SetPointPS software. The BOOTP/DHCP utility is a standalone program
that is a separate program available as part of the Rockwell Software suite. The
utility is located in the BOOTPDHCP Server folder that is accessed from the
Start menu.
IMPORTANT Before starting the BOOTP/DHCP utility, make sure that you have the
hardware MAC ID of the module. The module is located in the Port Settings
section while connected through the SetPointPS software. The module can
also be accessed from the Ethernet display screens from the front panel. The
MAC ID has a format similar to the following: 00-0b-db-14-55-35.
4. Click OK.
The Request History panel displays the hardware addresses of modules
that are issuing BOOTP or DHCP requests.
5. Double-click the MAC address of the module to be configured.
IMPORTANT The MAC address of the relay can be located in the Port Settings while
connected through the SetPointPS software or in the Ethernet section from
the front panel displays.
The New Entry dialog appears with the Ethernet Address (MAC) of the
module.
When module power is cycled, it uses the assigned configuration and does not
issue a DHCP request.
Electronic Data Sheet (EDS) Before the 857 Relay is configured to communicate on an EtherNet/IP
network, it must be registered to the software that configures the network. For
File example, Rockwell Automation® RSLinx® Classic and RSNetWorx™ for
EtherNet/IP software). Register the module by installing an EDS file. EDS
files are simple text files that are used by network configuration tools to
identify products and commission them on a network. Relay firmware, version
13 and higher, supports an EtherNet/IP EDS AOP approach within the
Studio5000 environment. The EDS file for the 857 Protection System can be
obtained directly from the relay.
The EDS file for the 857 Protection System is embedded within the device. To
upload the file, use the SetPointPS software.
To upload the current EDS file for the device (recommended), use these steps.
The relay reads the EDS information from the relay in preparation to
create an EDS data file.
EDS Add On Profile Support The 857 with firmware version 13.001 or higher provides for EDS Add On
Profile (AOP) support. The EDS (AOP) feature in combination with
Rockwell Software® Logix Designer provides an easy integration path within
the Logix Designer environment. The EDS file format for the Ethernet
Common Industrial Protocol (CIP) networks is defined by ODVA.
The EDS file can be extracted directly from the 857 using the SetPointPS
software Configuration tool. The EDS AOP provides both the values for
Input and Output assembly and the tags for the static assembly selected. This
support is provided only for the static assemblies and the pre-configured in the
device. The selection of static assembly within Logix Designer must match the
selection that is made in the relay.
Predefined Static Ethernet The mapping for static assemblies is permanently programmed in the Read
Only Memory (ROM) of the 857 protection system. They cannot be modified
Input and Output Assemblies in any way and must be used as is. The content of the predefined static
assemblies, which exist within the 857 protection system with firmware version
13.001 or higher, are listed in the following tables. See Appendix C for more
information related to the parameters.
Table 146 - Summary of Static and Dynamic Assemblies (Version 13.001 or Higher Firmware)
Assembly Reference Name shown in Assembly Type 3 PH Voltage 857-RAA 857-RAD Protection Mode Parameter Count
Studio 5000 Transformers Support Support
Supported
2+50 Basic Static No No No(1) — 2
100+150 Configurable Dynamic Yes Yes Yes Motor/Feeder Up to 255
101+151 Static Advance Static No No No(1) Motor 31
102+152 Static Advance 2 Static 2 in Open Delta Yes No(1) Motor 50
103+153 Static Advance 3 Static 3 in ‘Y’ connected Yes No(1) Motor 50
104+154 Static Advance 4 Static 2 in Open Delta No No(1) Motor 38
105+155 Static Advance 5 Static 3 in ‘Y’ connected No No(1) Motor 38
106+156 Static Advance 6 Static 2 in Open Delta No No(1) Feeder 39
107+157 Static Advance 7 Static 3 in ‘Y’ connected No No(1) Feeder 39
(1) 857-RAD only supported via dynamic assembly.
This assembly is designed for configurations where the 857 protection system
that has no voltage potential connections and NO RTD scanner connected.
Table 148 - 101+151 Advanced Static Assembly (Static Advanced) Parameter List
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
4 0x29 10 Control Supervisor Faulted 1 1=1 000 Producing
5 0x29 11 Control Supervisor Warning 1 1=1 001
7 0x29 13 Control Supervisor Fault Code 1 See Appendix 002
A for details
8 0x29 14 Control Supervisor Warn Code 1 See Appendix 003
A for details
11 0x2C 6 Overload %Phase Unbalance 1 1% =1 004
12 0x2C 7 Overload %Thermal 1 1% =1 005
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 006
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 007
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 008
10 0x2C 5 Overload Average Current 2 1A=1 012
13 0x2C 8 Overload Current L1 2 1 A=1 014
14 0x2C 9 Overload Current L2 2 1A=1 016
15 0x2C 10 Overload Current L3 2 1 A=1 018
16 0x2C 11 Overload Ground Current 2 1A=1 020
78 0x382 62 857/865 Digital N> alarm 1 1=1 022
80 0x382 64 857/865 Digital Motor starting 1 1=1 023
17 0x382 1 857/865 Digital Digital inputs 4 1=1 024
18 0x382 2 857/865 Digital Output relays 4 1=1 028
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 032
81 0x382 65 857/865 Digital Motor running 1 1=1 036
896 0x382 170 857/865 Digital Virtual output 1 1 1=1 037
897 0x382 171 857/865 Digital Virtual output 2 1 1=1 038
898 0x382 172 857/865 Digital Virtual output 3 1 1=1 039
899 0x382 173 857/865 Digital Virtual output 4 1 1=1 040
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 041
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 042
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008
Table 149 - 102+152 Advanced Static Assembly 2 (Static Advanced 2) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Offset Assembly Type
Number number Count
379 0x383 194 857/865 Analog External AI7 4 1.00C=100 064 Producing
380 0x383 195 857/865 Analog External AI8 4 1.00C=100 068
381 0x383 196 857/865 Analog External AI9 4 1.00C=100 072
382 0x383 197 857/865 Analog External AI10 4 1.00C=100 076
383 0x383 198 857/865 Analog External AI11 4 1.00C=100 080
384 0x383 199 857/865 Analog External AI12 4 1.00C=100 084
842 0x384 1 857/865 Analog 2 Frequency 4 50.000 Hz=5000 088
846 0x384 5 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage U12 4 1000V=1000 092
847 0x384 6 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage U23 4 1000V=1000 096
848 0x384 7 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage U31 4 1000V=1000 100
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00=100 104
854 0x384 13 857/865 Analog 2 Average line voltage 4 1000V=1000 108
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 112
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008
Table 150 - 103+153 Advanced Static Assembly 3 (Static Advanced 3) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
81 0x382 65 857/865 Digital Motor running 1 1=1 008 Producing
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 009
10 0x2C 5 Overload Avg. Current 2 1 A=1 010
13 0x2C 8 Overload CurrentL1 2 1 A=1 012
14 0x2C 9 Overload CurrentL2 2 1 A=1 014
15 0x2C 10 Overload CurrentL3 2 1 A=1 016
16 0x2C 11 Overload Ground Current 2 1 A=1 018
17 0x382 1 857/865 Digital Digital inputs 4 1=1 020
18 0x382 2 857/865 Digital Output relays 4 1=1 026
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 030
896 0x382 170 857/865 Digital Virtual output 1 1 1=1 031
897 0x382 171 857/865 Digital Virtual output 2 1 1 =1 032
898 0x382 172 857/865 Digital Virtual output 3 1 1=1 033
899 0x382 173 857/865 Digital Virtual output 4 1 1=1 034
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 035
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 036
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 037
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1.00C= 100 038
373 0x383 188 857/865 Analog External AI1 4 1.00C= 100 042
374 0x383 189 857/865 Analog External AI2 4 1.00C= 100 044
375 0x383 190 857/865 Analog External AI3 4 1.00C= 100 048
376 0x383 191 857/865 Analog External AI4 4 1.00C= 100 052
377 0x383 192 857/865 Analog External AI5 4 1.00C= 100 056
378 0x383 193 857/865 Analog External AI6 4 1.00C= 100 060
379 0x383 194 857/865 Analog External AI7 4 1.00C= 100 064
380 0x383 195 857/865 Analog External AI8 4 1.00C= 100 068
381 0x383 196 857/865 Analog External AI9 4 1.00C= 100 072
382 0x383 197 857/865 Analog External AI10 4 1.00C = 100 076
383 0x383 198 857/865 Analog External AI11 4 1.00C = 100 080
384 0x383 199 857/865 Analog External AI12 4 50.000 Hz = 084
5000
842 0x384 1 857/865 Analog 2 Frequency 4 1.00 = 100 088
850 0x384 9 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage UL1 4 1000 v = 1000 092
851 0x384 10 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageUL2 4 1000V= 1000 096
852 0x384 11 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage UL3 4 1000V= 1000 100
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00 = 100 104
855 0x384 14 857/865 Analog 2 Average phase voltage 4 1000V = 1000 108
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 112
Table 150 - 103+153 Advanced Static Assembly 3 (Static Advanced 3) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008
Table 151 - 104+154 Advanced Static Assembly 4 (Static Advanced 4) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 035 Producing
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 036
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 037
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 038
842 0x384 1 857/865 Analog 2 Frequency 4 50.000 042
Hz=5000
846 0x384 5 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageU12 4 1000V = 1000 044
847 0x384 6 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageU23 4 1000V = 1000 048
848 0x384 7 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage U31 4 1000V = 1000 052
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00 = 100 056
854 0x384 13 857/865 Analog 2 Average line voltage 4 1000V=1000 060
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 064
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008
Table 152 - 105+155 Advanced Static Assembly 5 (Static Advanced 5) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
10 0x2C 5 Overload Avg. Current 2 1% =1 010 Producing
13 0x2C 8 Overload CurrentL1 2 1 A=1 012
14 0x2C 9 Overload CurrentL2 2 1 A=1 014
15 0x2C 10 Overload CurrentL3 2 1 A=1 016
16 0x2C 11 Overload Ground Current 2 1 A=1 018
17 0x382 1 857/865 Digital Digital inputs 4 1=1 020
18 0x382 2 857/865 Digital Output relays 4 1=1 026
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 030
896 0x382 170 857/865 Digital Virtual output 1 1 1=1 031
897 0x382 171 857/865 Digital Virtual output 2 1 1=1 032
898 0x382 172 857/865 Digital Virtual output 3 1 1=1 033
899 0x382 173 857/865 Digital Virtual output 4 1 1=1 034
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 035
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 036
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 037
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 038
842 0x384 1 857/865 Analog 2 Frequency 4 50.000 042
Hz=5000
850 0x384 9 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage UL1 4 1000V = 1000 044
851 0x384 10 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageUL2 4 1000V = 1000 048
852 0x384 11 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage UL3 4 1000V = 1000 052
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00 = 100 056
855 0x384 14 857/865 Analog 2 Average line voltage 4 1000V = 1000 060
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 064
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008
Table 153 - 106+156 Advanced Static Assembly 6 (Static Advanced 6) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
845 0x384 4 857/865 Analog 2 Apparent power 4 1000 052 Producing
kVA=1000
846 0x384 5 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageU12 4 1000V = 1000 056
847 0x384 6 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageU23 4 1000V = 1000 060
848 0x384 7 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage U31 4 1000V = 1000 064
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00 = 100 068
854 0x384 13 857/865 Analog 2 Average line voltage 4 1000V = 1000 072
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1 =1 076
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008
Table 154 - 107+157 Advanced Static Assembly 7 (Static Advanced 7) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
18 0x382 2 857/865 Digital Output relays 4 1=1 024 Producing
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 028
896 0x382 170 857/865 Digital Virtual output 1 1 1=1 032
897 0x382 171 857/865 Digital Virtual output 2 1 1=1 033
898 0x382 172 857/865 Digital Virtual output 3 1 1=1 034
899 0x382 173 857/865 Digital Virtual output 4 1 1=1 035
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 036
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 037
819 0x387 108 857/865 StgProtO CBFP Enable for CBFP 1 Off=0, On=1 038
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 039
842 0x384 1 857/865 Analog 2 Frequency 4 50.000 Hz= 040
5000
843 0x384 2 857/865 Analog 2 Active power 4 1000 044
kW=1000
844 0x384 3 857/865 Analog 2 Reactive power 4 1000kvar = 048
1000
845 0x384 4 857/865 Analog 2 Apparent power 4 1000 052
kVA=1000
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00 = 100 056
846 0x384 5 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageUL1 4 1000V = 1000 060
847 0x384 6 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageUL2 4 1000V = 1000 064
848 0x384 7 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage UL3 4 1000V = 1000 068
854 0x384 13 857/865 Analog 2 Average line voltage 4 1000V = 1000 072
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 076
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008
Notes:
Applications
Substation Feeder Protection The feeder device includes three-phase overcurrent protection, directional
earth-fault-protection, and fast arc protection. At the incoming feeder, the
instantaneous stage I>>> of the 857 feeder devices is blocked with the start
signal of the overcurrent stage. This block helps prevent the trip signal if the
fault occurs on the outgoing feeder.
Figure 152 - 857 Feeder and Motor Devices That Are Used in Substation Feeder Protection
857
857
The function I0sinϕ is used in isolated networks, and the function I0cosϕ is used
in resistance or resonant earthed networks.
Figure 153 - 857 Feeder and Motor Devices That Are Used in Cable Protection of an Industry
Plant Network
857
857
vamp257app2
Parallel Line Protection Figure 154 shows two parallel lines, A and B, protected with overcurrent relays
R1, R2, R3, and R4. The relays R3 and R4 are directional.
Figure 154 - Feeder and Motor Device Allen-Bradley 857 Used for Protection of Parallel Lines
LOAD
R1 R3
A
LOAD
SUPPLY
B
LOAD
R2 R4
If there is a fault in one of the lines, only the faulty line is switched off because
of the direction functions of the relays R3 and R4. A detailed schematic of, for
example, the relay R3 is shown in Figure 155.
+
option 2
option 1
X3:14
X3:15
X3:12
X3:13
X7:17
X7:18
X7:15
X7:16
X8:19
X8:20
X8:17
X8:18
X8:15
X8:16
X8:13
X8:14
X3:11
X3:10
X2:10
X2:11
X3:9
X2:7
X2:8
X2:5
X2:6
X2:3
X2:4
X2:1
X2:2
X2:9
X10
X9
Front
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
T7
T8
IF
Extension port
Remote port
Local port
857-3C7xxx
Optio n Block
DI
DI
DI
DI
Comm
~
Comm
X8:9 Comm
Comm
Comm
X8:3 Comm
+48V
DI12
X7:10 DI15
X7:13 DI18
DI10
DI13
DI14
X7:11 DI16
X7:12 DI17
DI26
DI25
DI11
DI24
X8:11 DI28
DI23
X8:10 DI27
DI22
DI21
U12
U23
DI6
DI2
DI5
DI9
DI1
DI3
DI4
DI7
DI8
U0
I01
I02
IL1
IL2
IL3
X8:12
X7:14
X1:13
X1:17
X3:17
X3:18
X1:10
X1:12
X1:14
X1:18
X1:11
X6:1
X6:2
X6:3
X6:4
X6:5
X6:6
X6:7
X3:1
X3:2
X3:3
X3:4
X3:5
X3:6
X3:7
X7:1
X7:2
X7:3
X7:4
X7:5
X7:6
X7:7
X7:8
X7:9
X8:1
X8:2
X8:4
X8:5
X8:6
X8:7
X8:8
X1:1
X1:3
X1:4
X1:5
X1:6
X1:7
X1:8
X1:9
X1:2
−
Ring Network Protection Ring networks can be selectively protected, by using directional overcurrent
relays, as long as there is only one feeding point in the network. Figure 156
shows an example of a ring main with five nodes that use one circuit breaker at
each end of each line section (for example a ring main unit). When there is a
short-circuit fault in any line section, only the faulty section is disconnected.
The grading time in this example is 150 ms.
Figure 156 - Feeder Terminals, 857 Protection System Used for Protection of Ring Main Circuit
with One Feeding Point
LOAD 2
SupPLY LOAD 1
LOAD 4
LOAD 5
Trip Circuit Supervision Trip circuit supervision is used to make sure that the wiring from a protective
device to a circuit-breaker is in order. The circuit is unused most of the time.
When a protection device detects a fault in the network, it is too late to notice
that the circuit-breaker cannot be tripped because of broken trip circuitry.
The digital inputs of the device can be used for trip circuit monitoring. The
dry digital inputs are most suitable for trip circuit supervision. The first six
digital inputs of 857 Protection Systems are not dry contacts and an auxiliary
miniature relay is needed, if these inputs are used for trip circuit supervision.
The optimum digital inputs for trip circuit supervision are inputs
DI29…DI32, which are internally wired in parallel within trip relays T5…T8.
These inputs do not share the common terminal with other inputs.
DI29…DI32 and T5…T8 are optional by catalog number.
The drawback is that an external resistor must supervise the trip circuit on both
CB positions. If supervision during the closed position only is enough, the
resistor is not needed.
• The digital input is connected parallel with the trip contacts
(Figure 157).
• The digital input is configured as Normal Closed (NC).
• The digital input delay is configured longer than maximum fault time to
inhibit any unnecessary trip circuit fault alarm when the trip contact is
closed.
• The trip relay must be configured as non-latched. Otherwise the trip
contact operates, a superfluous trip-circuit fault alarm is raised, and the
relay remains closed because of latching.
By using an auxiliary contact of the CB for the external resistor, the auxiliary
contact in the trip circuit can be supervised.
• When using the dry digital input DI7, there is limited use of the other
inputs of the same group and limited common terminal sharing.
• When using the wet digital inputs DI1…DI6, an auxiliary relay is
needed.
Figure 157 - Trip Circuit Supervision When the Circuit Breaker Is Closed
The supervised circuitry in this CB +V AUX
position is double-lined. The digital
input is in active state. For the Trip circuit
application to work when the circuit- failure alarm
breaker is opened, a resistor R1 must Digital input
be placed. The value for it can be
calculated from the external wetting
supply, so that the current over R1 is
>1 mA.
Trip relay
Alarm relay
for trip circuit
Relay compartment
Circuit breaker compartment
Close Control
R1
-V AUX
Open Coil
CB
-V AUX
Close Coil
Figure 158 - Trip Circuit Supervision When the Circuit Breaker Is Open
The supervised circuitry in this CB +V AUX = 24…240V DC
position is doubled-lined. The value for 857 Relay Digital input
R1 in this application is 3k3 and 2 W.
These values can be calculated from the
resistance and voltage operating range
of the coil of K1 and the tolerance of the
wetting voltage.
Trip relay
Relay compartment
-V AUX
Open Coil
CB
R -V AUX
Close Coil
If DI7 is used for trip circuit supervision, the usage of DI8…DI14 is limited to
the same circuitry that shares the Vaux in the common terminal.
Figure 159 - Example of a Digital Input DI7 Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with One
Dry Digital Input
Figure 160 - Example of Output Matrix Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with One Dry
Digital Input
Rated power of the open coil of the circuit breaker. If this value is not known,
0Ω can be used for the RCoil :
• UMIN = UAUX - 20% = 88V
• UMAX = UAUX + 10% = 121V
• RCoil = U2AUX/P = 242 Ω
Equation 8.1
U MIN – U DI – I DI • R coil
R = -----------------------------------------------------------
-
I DI
In practice, the coil resistance has no effect. By selecting the next smaller
standard size, we get 22 kΩ.
The power rating for the external resistor is estimated using Equation 8.2 and
Equation 8.3. The Equation 8.2 is for the CB open situation including a 100%
safety margin to limit the maximum temperature of the resistor.
Equation 8.2
2
P = 2 • I DI • R
EXAMPLE 2
P = 2 • 0.003 • 22000 = 0.40 W
When the trip contacts are still closed and the CB is open, the resistor must
withstand much higher power (Equation 8.3) for this short time.
Equation 8.3
2
U MAX
P = --------------
-
R
EXAMPLE 2
122 - = 0.67 W
P = --------------
22000
A 0.5 W resistor is enough for this short time peak-power, too. However, if the
trip relay is closed for longer time than a few seconds, use a 1 W resistor.
In this scheme, an auxiliary relay must connect the wet digital input to the trip
circuit (Figure 161). The rated coil voltage of the auxiliary relay is selected
according to the rated auxiliary voltage that is used in the trip circuit. The
operating voltage range of the relay must be as wide as possible to cover the
tolerance of the auxiliary voltage.
In this application, the use of other wet inputs for other purposes is not limited
unlike, when using the dry inputs.
0.5 s
Relay compartment
-V AUX Relay K1
Open Coil EMG 17-REL/KSR-120/21-21-LC Au
Coil: 96…127V, 20 kΩ
CB
R
-V AUX
Close Coil
Figure 162 - Digital Input DI1 Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with One Wet Digital
Input
Figure 163 - Output Matrix Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with One Wet Digital
Input
Auxiliary voltage with tolerance. Short time voltage dips more than 5% are not
critical from the trip circuit supervision point of view.
Equation 8.4
U MIN – U K1MIN
R = --------------------------------------
- = R Coil
I K1MIN
The power rating for the external resistor is calculated using Equation 8.5. This
equation includes a 100% safety margin to limit the maximum temperature of
the resistor, because modern resistors are hot at their rated maximum power.
Equation 8.5
2
P = 2 • I K1MAX • R
EXAMPLE 2
P = 2 • 0.0061 • 1500R = 0.11 W
When the trip contacts are still closed and the CB is open, the resistor must
withstand much higher power (Equation 8.6) for this short time.
Equation 8.6
2
121 -
P = ----------- = 9.8 W
1500
The drawbacks are that two digital inputs from two separate groups are needed
and two extra wires from the relay to the CB compartment are needed.
Additionally, the minimum allowed auxiliary voltage is 48V DC, which is
more than twice the threshold voltage of the dry digital input. When the CB is
in the open position, the two digital inputs are in series.
• The first digital input is connected parallel with the trip contacts
(Figure 164).
• Another auxiliary contact is connected in series with the circuitry of the
first digital input. This makes it possible to supervise the auxiliary
contact in the trip circuit.
• The second digital input is connected parallel with the auxiliary contact
of the circuit breaker.
• Both inputs are configured as normal closed (NC).
The programmable logic is used to combine the digital input signals with an
AND port. The delay is configured longer than the maximum fault time to
inhibit any superfluous trip-circuit fault alarm when the trip contact is closed.
• The output from the logic is connected to a relay in the output matrix
that gives out any trip circuit alarm.
• Configure the trip relay as non-latched. Otherwise, the trip contact
operates, a superfluous trip-circuit fault alarm follows, and the relay
remains closed because of latching.
• Both digital inputs must have their own common potential. The use of
the other digital inputs in the same group as the upper DI in Figure 164
is not possible in most applications. The use of the other digital inputs in
the same group as the lower DI in Figure 164 is limited. Because the
whole group is tied to the auxiliary voltage Vaux.
TIP For some applications, the optimal digital inputs for trip circuit supervision
are the optional inputs DI19 and DI20 because they do not share their
terminals with any other digital inputs.
Figure 164 - Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Dry Digital Inputs
The circuit breaker is closed. The +V AUX = 48…240V DC
supervisory circuit in this circuit 857 Relay
breaker position is double-lined.
The digital input state is in active
state when the trip circuit is Digital Inputs
complete. Applicable for dry
inputs DI7…DI20 only. comm
Trip relay
Relay compartment
Circuit breaker compartment
Close Control
-V AUX
Open Coil
CB
-V AUX
Close Coil
Trip relay
Relay compartment
Circuit breaker compartment
Close Control
-V AUX
Open Coil
CB
-V AUX
Close Coil
TIP If DI13 and DI7 are used as the upper and lower digital inputs. The usage of
DI8… DI14 is limited to the same circuitry shared by the Vaux in the
common terminal. The DI14… DI18 and cannot be used, because they
share a common terminal with DI13.
Figure 166 - Digital Input Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Dry Digital Inputs
DI7 and DI13
Figure 167 - Logic Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Dry Digital Inputs DI7
and DI13
Figure 168 - Output Matrix Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Dry Digital
Inputs
X3 X6 X8 X7 X1
+48V 1 BI DI7 1
1
(TTL)
DI1 2 BO DI8
REMOTE
2 2 IL1 (S2)
IL1 (S1)
2
DI2 3 COM DI9 3 1
3
IL2 (S2)
Connections
A1 NC 11 DI16
11
A4 4 11
Ub
T2 12 DI17 Ub 14
A3 5 12 13
T2 13 DI18 13 --
A3 6 16
-- 15
T1 14 COM2 14
A2 7 Uc
T1 15 T4 15 Uc 18
A2 8 17
-- 16 T4 16
IF COM 9 20 --
Uaux 17 T3 -- 19
IF NC 10 17
Uaux 18 T3
IF NO 11 18
protect) through the following measuring and control connections.
X2
Chapter
323
324
Chapter 9
Connections
X3 X6 X8 X7 X1
DI21 1
+48V 1 BI DI22 DI7 1
1 2
(TTL)
DI1 2 BO Com. DI8
REMOTE
2 3 2 IL1 (S2)
IL1 (S1)
2
DI2 3 COM DI23 DI9 3 1
3 4
DI3 S1> + IL2 (S2)
4 4 DI24 5 DI10 4 4
IL2 (S1) 3
DI4 5 S1> Com. 6 DI11 5
5 IL3 (S2)
DI5 S2> + IL3 (S1)
6
6 6 DI25 7 DI12 6 5
Io1/
DI6 7 S2> 7 DI26 8 COM1 7 Io1/ 8 1A(S2)
1A(S1) 7
-- 8 Com. 9 DI13 8
A5- 1 Io2/
Io2/ 10 5A(S2)
A1 COM 9 DI27 10 DI14 9 9
A5 2 5A(S1)
DI28 Ua
A1 NO 10 11 DI15 10
A1 NC 11 Com. 12 DI16
11
A4 4 11
Ub
T2 12 T8 13 DI17 Ub 14
A3 5 12 13
T2 T8 14
13 DI18 13 --
A3 6 16
--
T1 14 T7 15 COM2 14
15
A2 7 Uc
T1 T7 16 Uc
15 A2 8 T4 15 18
17
-- T6 17
16 T4 16
IF COM 9 20 --
Uaux T6 18 --
17 T3 17 19
IF NC 10
T5 19
Uaux 18 T3
IF NO 11 18
T5 20
X2
X3 X6 X8 X7 X1
T14
1
+48V 1 BI DI7 1
1 T14 2
(TTL)
DI1 2 BO DI8
REMOTE
2 T13 3 2 IL1 (S2)
IL1 (S1)
2
DI2 3 COM DI9 1
3 T13 4 3
DI3 S1> + IL2 (S2)
4 4 T12 5 DI10 4 4
IL2 (S1) 3
DI4 5 S1> T12 6 DI11 5
5 IL3 (S2)
DI5 S2> + IL3 (S1)
6
6 6 T11 7 DI12 6 5
Io1/
DI6 7 S2> T11 8 COM1 7 Io1/ 1A(S2)
7 8
T10 1A(S1) 7
-- 8 9 DI13 8 Io2/
A5- 1
Io2/ 10 5A(S2)
A1 COM 9 T10 10 DI14
A5 2 9 5A(S1)
9
T9 Ua
A1 NO 10 11 DI15 10
A1 NC 11 T9 12 DI16
11
A4 4 11
Ub
T2 12 T8 13 DI17 Ub 14
A3 5 12 13
T2 T8 14
13 DI18 13 --
A3 6 16
--
T1 14 T7 15 COM2 14
15
A2 7 Uc
T1 T7 16 Uc
15 A2 8 T4 15 18
17
-- T6 17
16 T4 16
IF COM 9 20 --
Uaux T6 18 --
17 T3 17 19
IF NC 10
T5 19
Uaux 18 T3
IF NO 11 18
T5 20
Connections
X2
325
Chapter 9
Chapter 9 Connections
Auxiliary Voltage The external auxiliary voltage Uaux (standard 40…265V AC or DC) for the
terminal is connected to the terminals X3: 17…18.
The physical location of the communication options is at the back of the relay.
The option modules can be installed at the site, but the built-in Ethernet
modules are installed at the factory.
Figure 172 - Example of Allen-Bradley 857 Back Panel Serial Communication Connection
X3 X6 X8 X7 X1
REMOTE
1
(TTL)
1 2 1
2 3 2
1 2
3 4 3
4 5 4
3 4
5 6 5
5 6
6 7 6
7 8 7
7 8
8 9 8
1
9 10 9 9 10
2
10 11 10 12
3 11
11 12 11
4
12 13 12 13 14
5
13 14 13
6
15 16
14 15 14
7
15 8
16 15 17 18
16 17 16
9 20
17 10
18
17 19
19
18 11 18
20
X2
The communication modules convert the RS-232 signal levels to some other
levels, for example, TTL, RS-485 or fiber-optics. The modules can contain
intelligence to make protocol conversion on software level.
Remote TX X3-4
Remote RX X3-5
+8Vdc X3-6
X3-7
X3-8
Local TX X3-9
Local RX
X3-10
UART_OUT X3-11
Sync. in X3-12
OPTx_ID X3-13
X3-14
31 mm (1.2 in.)
External connector,
signal levels depend
on the type of the
module
External connector
18 mm (0.71 in.)
The communication module types and their pin assignments are introduced in
these tables.
S1 S2
Open Open
1 2 1 2
1 2 3 4 5 6
Off Off
Remote Termination ON
On S1 On S2
1 2 3 4 5 6
Off Off
S1 S2
Local
On S1 On S2
1 2 3 4 5 6
Off Off
S1 1 2 S23 4 5 6 4 3 2 1
Off On
Remote Termination OFF, 4-wire
Off
1 2 3 4 5 6 4 3 2 1
On
S2 S1 Termination OFF, 2-wire
Local
On Off
1 2 3 4 5 6 4 3 2 1
Off On
1 2 3 4 5 6
Off
S1:1 Echo ON
S1:2 IDLE light OFF
S1 S1:3,5 REMOTE OFF
S1:4,6 LOCAL ON
On S1
1 2 3 4 5 6
Off
TIP Connect DSR to DTR to activate the front panel connector and disable the
rear panel X4 RS-232 port. The other port in the same X4 connector is not
disabled.
Optional Two-channel Arc The optional arc protection card includes two arc sensor channels. The arc
sensors are connected to terminals X6: 4-5 and 6-7.
Protection Card
The arc information can be transmitted and/or received through digital input
and output channels. A 48V DC signal.
TIP When this option card is installed, the parameter “Arc card type” has value
“2Arc+BI/O”.
TIP If the slot X6 is occupied with the DI19/DI20 digital input card, this option is
not available. There is still one arc sensor channel available (see Optional
Digital I/O Card (DI19/DI20) on page 338).
Activate the binary output of the arc option card by using the arc sensors or by
any available signal in the output matrix. The binary output can be connected
to an arc binary input of another Allen-Bradley® protection device or other
compatible product.
Optional Digital I/O Card The DI19/DI20 option permits two more digital inputs. These inputs are
useful in applications where the contact signals are not potential free. For
(DI19/DI20) example, trip circuit supervision is such an application. The inputs are
connected to terminals X6:1 – X6:2 and X6:3 – X6:4.
TIP When this option card is installed, the parameter “Arc card type” has value
“Arc+2DI”. With DI19/DI20 option, only one arc sensor channel is available.
TIP If the slot X6 is occupied with the two-channel arc sensor card, this option is
not available.
The 857 device supports optional external input/output modules that are used
to extend the system capabilities. A module for analog inputs and outputs is
available. These types of devices are supported:
• 12-channel RTD scanner, 857-RAA.
• 12-channel RTD scanner with analog inputs and outputs, and a
thermistor input, 857-RAD. See publication 857-UM002.
Block Diagrams
Figure 181 - Block Diagram of Allen-Bradley 857-3C6
Figure 185 - Block Diagram of Optional D10/D20 Module with One Arc Channel
L2
mode is set to “2LL+U0”.
The voltage measurement
L3
+ 1 -
- 0
X3:17 ~ Front
X3:18 Communication
Local port option 1
Remote port X9
X1:1 IL1
Extension port
X1:2 Communication
X1:3 option 2
IL2 X10
X1:4
X1:5 IL3
X1:6
T1 X3:14
X1:7 I01
X1:8 X3:15
X1:9 I02
U
T2 X3:12
X1:10
X1:11 U12
X1:12 X3:13 U
X1:13 T3 X7:17
U23
Connection Examples
X1:14
X7:18
T4 X7:15
X1:17 U0
X1:18
Option Block X7:16
X6:1 T5 X8:19
X6:2
X6:3 X8:20
X6:4 X8:17
857-3C7
X6:5 T6
X6:6
X6:7 X8:18
T7 X8:15
VAMP 255 +48V
X3:1 DI
DI1
DI8 DI X3:10
X7:2
X7:3 DI9 A2 X2:7
X7:4 DI10
X7:5 DI11
DI12 X2:8
X7:6 X2:5
X7:7 Comm A3
X2:6
X7:8 DI13 A4 X2:3
DI14 DI
X7:9
X7:10 DI15 X2:4
X7:11 DI16 A5 X2:1
X7:12 DI17
X7:13 DI18
X7:14 Comm X2:2
IF X2:9
DI21
X8:1 X2:10
X8:2 DI22 DI
Comm X2:11
X8:3
Connections
X8:4 DI23
DI24
X8:5
Comm
X8:6 DI25
X8:7 DI26
X8:8
X8:9 Comm
X8:10 DI27
X8:11 DI28
Comm
X8:12
343
Chapter 9
344
L1
Chapter 9
L2
L3
Connections
+ 1 -
- 0
The device is calculating the residual voltage. The voltage
X3:17 Front
~
X3:18 Communication
Local port option 1
Remote port X9
X1:1 Extension port
X1:2 IL1 Communication
X1:3 option 2
X1:4 IL2 X10
X1:5 IL3
X1:6
T1 X3:14
X1:7 I01
X1:8
X3:15
X1:9 U
I02 T2 X3:12
X1:10
X1:11
X1:12 UL1 X3:13 U
X1:13 T3 X7:17
X1:14 UL2
X1:17 X7:18
X1:18 UL3
T4 X7:15
Option Block
X6:1 X7:16
X6:2 X8:19
T5
X6:3
X6:4
X6:5 X8:20
857-3C7
X6:6 X8:17
T6
X6:7
+48V X8:18
X3:1 DI1 DI
X3:2 T7 X8:15
DI2
X3:3 DI3
X3:4 DI4 X8:16
L2
L3 polarizing U0 voltage.
+
1 -
+
The voltage measurement mode is set to “2LL+U0”.
- 0
Directional earth-fault stages are not available without the
X3:17 Front
~
Communication
X3:18
Local port option 1
Remote port X9
X1:1 Extension port
X1:2 IL1 Communication
option 2
X1:3
IL2 X10
X1:4
Transformer
X1:5 IL3
X1:6
T1 X3:14
X1:7
I01
X1:8
X3:15
X1:9 U
I02 X3:12
X1:10 T2
X1:11
X1:12 U12 X3:13 U
X1:13 T3 X7:17
X1:14 U23
X1:17 X7:18
X1:18 U0
T4 X7:15
Option Block
X6:1 X7:16
X6:2 X8:19
T5
X6:3
X6:4
X8:20
857-3C7
X6:5
X6:6 X8:17
T6
X6:7
+48V X8:18
X3:1 DI1 DI
T7 X8:15
VAMP 255 X3:2 DI2
X3:3 DI3
X3:4 DI4 X8:16
X3:5 DI5 T8 X8:13
X8:7 DI26
X8:8 Comm
X8:9 DI27
Figure 188 - Connection Example of Allen-Bradley 857-3C7 with V-connected Voltage
X8:10
DI28
X8:11 Comm
X8:12
345
Chapter 9
L1
346
Chapter 9
L2
L3
Connections
+ 1 -
- 0
+
The voltage measurement mode is set to “2LL+U0”.
X3:17 Front
~
Communication
X3:18
Local port option 1
Remote port X9
X1:1 Extension port
X1:2 IL1
Communication
X1:3 option 2
X1:4 IL2
X10
X1:5
IL3
X1:6
T1 X3:14
X1:7 I01
X1:8
X3:15 U
X1:9 I02
X1:10 T2 X3:12
X1:11
X1:12 U12 X3:13 U
X1:13 T3 X7:17
X1:14 U23
X7:18
T4 X7:15
X1:17
X1:18 U0
Option Block X7:16
X6:1 T5 X8:19
X6:2
X6:3 X8:20
X6:4 X8:17
857-3C7
X6:5 T6
X6:6
X6:7 X8:18
T7 X8:15
X3:1 +48V
X3:2 DI1 DI
X8:16
X3:3 DI2
DI21 X2:2
X8:1
X8:2 DI22 DI IF X2:9
X8:3 Comm
X2:10
X8:4 DI23
DI24 X2:11
X8:5
Comm
X8:6
DI25
X8:7
X8:8 DI26
Comm
Figure 189 - Connection Example of Allen-Bradley 857-3C7 as a Motor Protection Device
X8:9
X8:10 DI27
X8:11 DI28
Comm
M X8:12
Chapter 10
Specifications
- Burden 0.125VA
- Impedance 0.005 Ohms
I01 Input, Option C / I012 Input, Option D(1) 1 A (configurable for CT secondaries 0.1…10.0 A)
Rated residual current 0…10 A
- Current measurement range 4 A (continuously)
- Thermal withstand 20 A (for 10 s), 100 A (for 1 s)
- Burden 0.04VA
- Impedance 0.04 Ohms
I01 Input, Option D(1) 0.2 A (configurable for CT secondaries 0.1…10.0 A)
Rated residual current (optional) 0…2 A
- Current measurement range 0.8 A (continuously)
- Thermal withstand 4 A (for 10 s), 20 A (for 1 s)
- Burden 0.04VA
- Impedance 0.04 Ohms
Serial Numbers < 857- Serial Numbers > 857-
001071 001070
Rated voltage Un Configurable for VT Configurable for VT
Secondaries of 50…120V Secondaries of 50…400V(2)
(110/110V default) (110/110V default)
Voltage measurement range 0…190V (100/110V) 0…260V (180/215V)(2)
Continuous voltage withstands 250V 250V
Burden <0.5 A <0.5 A
Rated frequency fn 45…65 Hz
- Frequency measurement range
Terminal block: Maximum wire dimension:
- Solid or stranded wire 4 mm2 (10…12 AWG)
(1) See Catalog Number Explanation on page 24.
(2) For configurable rated voltages greater than 215V (180V), the device must be wired to line-to-neutral voltages. The network
neutral must not be ungrounded. The given limit 215V allows 20% overvoltage.
IMPORTANT Maximally three arc binary inputs can be connected to one arc binary output
without an external amplifier.
Setting range:
- Motor start detection current 1.30…10.00 xIMOT (step 0.01)
- Nom motor start current 1.50…10.00 xIMOT (step 0.01)
Delay Type DT, INV
Definite time characteristic DT:
- operating time 1.0…300.0 s (step 0.1)(1)
Inverse time characteristic INV:
- Operational Delay 1.0…300.0 s (step 0.1)(1)
- Inverse Time Efficient (K) 1.0…200.0 s (step 0.1)
- Minimum motor stop time to activate stall protection 500 ms
- Maximum current raise times from motor stop to start 200 ms
Motor Stop Limit 0.10 x Imot(2)
Motor Running Lower Limit 0.20 x Imot(2)
Motor Running Limit after Starting 1.20 x Imot(2)
Start time Typically 60 ms
Reset time <95 ms
Resetting ratio 0.95
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±3% of the set value
- Operating time at definite time function ±1% or at ±30 ms
- Operating time at IDMT function ±5% or at least ±30 ms(1)
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.
(2) Motor is stopped and the running limits are based on the average of the three phase currents.
This stage is operational when all secondary currents are >250 mA.
Setting range: K2 2…70% (step 1%)
Definite time characteristic:
- operating time 1.0…600.0 s (step 0.1)
Inverse time characteristic:
- one characteristic curve Inv
- time multiplier K1 1…50 s (step 1)
- upper limit for inverse time 1000 s
Start time Typically 300 ms
Reset time <450 ms
Reset ratio 0.95
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±1% – unit
- Operate time ±5% or ±200 ms
Settings:
- Setting range of K2 2…70%
Definite time function:
- Operating time 1.0…600.0 s (step 0.3 s)
Start time Typically 200 ms
Reset time <450 ms
Reset ratio 0.95
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±1% unit
- Operate time ±5% or ± 200 ms
Table 194 - Earth Fault Stages I0>>, I0>>>, I0>>>> (50N/51N), (50G/51G)
Table 198 - Directional Intermittent Earth-fault Stages I0φ>, I0φ>> (67N) (Continued)
Inaccuracy:
- Starting U0 and I0 (rated value In= 1…5A) ±3% of the set value or ±0.3% of the rated value
- Starting U0 and I0 (Peak Mode when, rated value Ion= ±5% of the set value or ±2% of the rated value (sine-
1…10A) wave <65 Hz)
- Staring U0 and I0 (I0calc) ±3% of the set value or ±0.5% of the rated value
- Angle ±2° (when U>IV or I0>5% of rated value ION
- Operate time at definite time function ±1% or ±30 ms
- Operate time at IDMT function ±5% or at least ±30 ms(1)
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.
(2) EI = Extremely Inverse, NI = Normal Inverse, VI = Very Inverse, LTI = Long Time Inverse, MI= Moderately Inverse.
Voltage Protection
Table 200 - Overvoltage Stages U>, U>>, and U>>> (59)
Overvoltage setting range: 50…150%Un for U>, U>>(1)
50…160% Un for U>>>(1)
Definite time characteristic:
- operating time 0.08(2)…300.00 s (step 0.01) (U>, U>>)
0.06(2)…300.00 s (step 0.01) (U>>>)
Start time Typically 60 ms
Reset time U> 0.06…300.00 s (step 0.01)
Reset time U>>, U>>> <95 ms
Retardation time <50 ms
Reset ratio 0.99…0.800 (0.1…20.0%, step 0.1%)
Inaccuracy:
- starting ±3% of the set value(1)
- operate time ±1% or ±30 ms
(1) The measurement range is up to 160V to limit the maximum usable setting when rated VT secondary is more than 100V.
(2) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.
Table 202 - Zero Sequence Voltage Stages U0> and U0>> (59N)
Frequency Protection
Table 203 - Overfrequency and Underfrequency Protection Stages f>< and f>><< (81)
Frequency measuring area 16.0…75.0 Hz
Current and voltage meas. range 45.0…65.0 Hz
Frequency stage setting range 40.0…70.0 Hz
Low voltage blocking (range of 45…65 Hz) 10…100%Un
Definite time function:
-operating time 0.10(1)…300.0 s (step 0.02 s)
Start time <100 ms
Reset time <120 ms
Reset ratio (f> and f>>) 0.998
Reset ratio (f< and f<<) 1.002
Reset ratio (LV block) 0.5V or 1.03 (3%)
Inaccuracy:
- starting ±20 MHz
- starting (LV block) 3% of the set value
- operating time ±1% or ± 30 ms
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.
Power Protection
Table 206 - Reverse Power and Underpower Stages P<, P<< (32)
Pick-up setting range -200.0…200.0% of SN (step 0.5)
Definite time function:
- Operating time 0.3…300.0 s (step 0.1)
Start time Typically 200 ms
Reset time <500 ms
Reset ratio 1.05
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±3% of set value or ± 0.5% of rated value
- Operating time at definite time function ±1% or ±150 ms
This stage is used to block other stages. The ratio between the second
harmonic component and the fundamental frequency component is measured
on all phase currents. When the ratio in any phase exceeds the setting value, the
stage gives a start signal.
After a settable delay, the stage gives a trip signal. The start and trip signals can
be used for blocking the other stages. The trip delay is irrelevant if only the start
signal is used for blocking. The trip delay of the stages to be blocked must be
more than 60 ms to help maintain proper blocking.
Pick up Settings:
- Setting range 2.Harmonic 10…100%
- Operation delay 0.05…300.00 s (step 0.01 s)
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±1% unit
The ratio between the over excitation component and the fundamental
frequency component is measured on all phase currents. When the ratio in any
phase exceeds the setting value, the stage gives a start signal. After a settable
delay, the stage gives a trip signal.
The trip delay of the stages to be blocked must be more than 60 ms to help
maintain proper blocking.
Settings:
- Setting range 5th Harmonic 10…100%
- Operating time 0.05…300.00 s (step 0.01 s)
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±2% unit
TIP The amplitude of fifth harmonic content must be at least 2% of the nominal
of CT secondary current. If the nominal current is 5 A, the 250 Hz component
is required to exceed 100 mA.
The arc protection operation depends on the setting value of the ArcI>, ArcI0>
and ArcI02> current limits. The arc current limits cannot be set unless the 857
relay can be provided with the optional arc protection card.
Transformer Supervision
Table 216 - Current Transformer Supervision
IMAX > setting 0.00…10.00 x IN (step 0.01)
IMIN < setting 0.00…10.00 x IN (step 0.01)
Definite time function: DT
- Operating time 0.04…600.00 s (step 0.01 s)
Reset time <60 ms
Reset ratio Imax> 0.97
Reset ratio Imin< 1.03
Inaccuracy:
- Activation ± 3% of the set value
- Operating time at definite time function ± 1% or ± 30 ms
IMPORTANT If one of the phase voltages is below sag limit and above block limit but
another phase voltage drops below block limit, blocking is disabled.
Voltage Interruptions
Table 219 - Voltage Interruptions
Voltage low limit (U1) 10…120% of UN (step 1%)
Definite time function: DT
- Operating time <50 ms (Fixed)
Reset time <60 ms
Reset ratio: 1.03
Inaccuracy:
- Activation 3% of the set value
Notes:
Installation
2a 2b
Dimensions are in millimeters
4
2
139
4
1
193
1.0
-10
m
m
208 mm 190 mm
(8.19 in.) (7.48 in.)
155 mm
(56.1 in.)
1.0…10.0 mm
(0.04…0.4 in.)
137 mm
(5.4 in.)
Parameter List
Overview This appendix lists all accessible parameters of the Bulletin 857 protection
system in numerical order. The setting range for each parameter is provided to
assist especially for applications where it is desirable to set values from a logic
controller via a network connection. The CIP class codes are provided for
troubleshooting purposes.
Information values that are provided are shown in the following table.
Value Function
Setting Range Indicated as raw numerical values
Scale Factor Indicate the decimal precision that is associated with
each parameter. Pay close attention to the decimal
when writing or reading values
Default Indicate that the factory pre-programmed values
The mode value determines the ability of the parameter to be read (Get),
written (Set) or both (Get/Set).
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
1 Misc. 0x389 1 1 byte 1 Byte padding-used when the USINT 1 Set
Parameter List
padding configuration tool requires assembly data to
be word or double-word aligned, to align
the assembly contents appropriately.
2 Misc. 0x389 2 2 bytes 2 Bytes padding-used when the UINT 2 Set
padding configuration tool requires assembly data to
be word or double-word aligned, to align
the assembly contents appropriately.
3 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 3 Run1 Run command from the network is BOOL 1 1 1= Running 0 Get/Set
internally blocked. Not used. 0= Stopped
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
4 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 10 Faulted Relay is in tripped condition BOOL 1 1 0 Get
Red Trip status indicator illuminated 1 = Trip Occurred (latched in programmed)
0 = No Faults present
5 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 11 Warning Relay is in an Alarm condition BOOL 1 1 0 Get
Amber Alarm status indicator illuminated 1 = Alarm Occurred (latched in programmed)
0 = N14o Alarm present
6 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 12 FaultRst Fault Reset BOOL 1 1 1 = Reset Fault 0 Get/Set
0 = No action
7 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 13 FaultCode If in Faulted state, FaultCode indicates the UINT 2 1 CurrTrip=20 0 Get
fault that caused the transition to Faulted ThermOverl=21
state. If not in Faulted state, Power up state PhasImbal=26
of fault code is 0. GndFault=27
Underload=29
Stall=31,
Undervol=51,
Overvol=52,
Phrevers=54,
Freq=55,
StHrExceed=73
(limit 65535)
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
8 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 14 WarnCode Code word indicating warnings present. UINT 2 1 CurrTrip=20 0 Get
ThermOverl=21
PhasImbal=26
GndFault=27
Underload=29
Stall=31,
Undervol=51,
Overvol=52,
Phrevers=54,
Freq=55,
StHrExceed=73
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
(limit 65535)
9 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 22 CycleCount Number of operations (motor starts) on the UDINT 4 1 0 1000000000 0 Get/Set
equipment
10 Over Load Object 0x2C 5 AvgCurrent Average Running Current INT 2 1=0.01 0 32767 0 Get
A
11 Over Load Object 0x2C 6 %PhImbal Percentage Phase Imbalance USINT 1 1 = 1% 0 127 0 Get
12 Over Load Object 0x2C 7 %Thermal Percentage Thermal Capacity USINT 1 1 = 1% 0 127 0 Get
13 Over Load Object 0x2C 8 CurrentL1 L1 Current INT 2 1=0.1 A 0 32767 0 Get
14 Over Load Object 0x2C 9 CurrentL2 L2 Current INT 2 1=0.1 A 0 32767 0 Get
15 Over Load Object 0x2C 10 CurrentL3 L3 Current INT 2 1=0.1 A 0 32767 0 Get
16 Over Load Object 0x2C 11 GroundCurr Ground Current INT 2 1=0.1 A 0 32767 0 Get
ent
Parameter List
Appendix A
373
374
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
17 Digital Object 0x382 1 Digital Digital Input State UDINT 4 1 Bit0= DI1 0 Get
inputs
Parameter List
0 = Input inactive Bit1= DI2
1 = Input active Bit2= DI3
Bit3= DI4
Bit4= DI5
Bit5= DI6
Bit6= DI7
Bit7= DI8
Bit8= DI9
Bit9= DI10
Bit10= DI11
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Bit11= DI12
Bit12= DI13
Bit13= DI14
Bit14= DI15
Bit15= DI16
Bit16= DI17
Bit17= DI18
Bit18= DI19
Bit19= DI20
Bit20= DI21
Bit21= DI22
Bit22= DI23
Bit23= DI24
Bit24= DI25
Bit25= DI26
Bit26= DI27
Bit27= DI28
Bit28= DI29
Bit29= DI30
Bit30= DI31
Bit31=DI32
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
18 Digital Object 0x382 2 Output Output Relay State UDINT 4 1 Bit0=T1 0 Get
relays Bit1=T2
0 = Output inactive Bit2=T3
1 = Output active Bit3=T4
Bit4=A1
T1=Trip relay 1, and so forth. Bit5=A2
A1=Alarm relay 1, and so forth. Bit6=A3
VO1=Virtual Output 1, and so forth. Bit7=A4
Bit8=A5
Bit9=BO
Bit10=T5
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Bit11=T6
Bit12=T7
Bit13=T8
Bit14=Not Used
Bit15=Not Used
Bit16=Alarm status indicator
Bit17=Trip status indicator
Bit18=status indicator A
Bit19=status indicator B
Bit20=status indicator C
Bit21=Dist. Rec.
Bit22=VO1
Bit23=VO2
Bit24=VO3
Bit25=VO4
Bit26=VO5
Bit27=VO6
Bit28=Not Used
Bit29=Not Used
Bit30=Not Used
Bit31=Not Used
19 Digital Object 0x382 3 Alive Alive indicator- Watch Dog OK USINT 2 1 1=Faulted 0 Get
indicator
Parameter List
Appendix A
375
376
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
20 Digital Object 0x382 4 Events Event Data from the device. UDINT 4 1=1 Bits 0 … 7 sec Since Genesis 0 Get
Parameter List
FIFO style. Individual reads to obtain UINT
sequential data UINT milliseconds
STRUCT- Bits 8...11
UDINT = sec Since Genesis event code
UINT =milliseconds Bits 12...15
UINT = event code
21 Digital Object 0x382 5 Obj1 state Object 1 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
22 Digital Object 0x382 6 Obj2 state Object 2 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
23 Digital Object 0x382 7 Obj3 state Object 3 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
24 Digital Object 0x382 8 Obj4 state Object 4 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
25 Digital Object 0x382 9 Obj5 state Object 5 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
26 Digital Object 0x382 10 Obj6 state Object 6 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
27 Digital Object 0x382 11 Remote/ Relay Control Mode BOOL 1 1 0=REMOTE 0 Get/Set
Local State 1=LOCAL
28 Digital Object 0x382 12 Open select Open select Obj1 BOOL 1 1 Open=1 0 Get/Set
Obj1 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
29 Digital Object 0x382 13 Close select Close select Obj1 BOOL 1 1 Close=1 0 Get/Set
Obj1 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
30 Digital Object 0x382 14 Execute Execute operation Obj1 BOOL 1 1 Execute Selection=1 0 Set
operation (enabled only in remote mode)
Obj1
31 Digital Object 0x382 15 Cancel Cancel selected operation BOOL 1 1 No Action=0 0 Set
selected (enabled only in remote mode) Cancel=1
operation
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
32 Digital Object 0x382 16 Max ctrl Maximum control pulse length of Obj1 UDINT 4 1=0.01 2 600000 0 Get/Set
pulse s
length of
Obj1
33 Digital Object 0x382 17 Open select Open select Obj2 BOOL 1 1 Open=1 0 Get/Set
Obj2 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
34 Digital Object 0x382 18 Close select Close select Obj2 BOOL 1 1 Close=1 0 Get/Set
Obj2 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
35 Digital Object 0x382 19 Execute Execute operation Obj2 BOOL 1 1 Execute Selection=1 0 Set
operation (enabled only in remote mode)
Obj2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
36 Digital Object 0x382 20 Max ctrl Maximum control pulse length of Obj2 UDINT 4 1=0.01 2 600000 0 Get/Set
pulse s
length of
Obj2
37 Digital Object 0x382 21 OM_MB_R Output Matrix BOOL 1 1 1=Reset 0 Get/Set
esetLatches Reset Latches
38 Digital Object 0x382 22 Synchronize Synchronize minutes BOOL 1 1 0 0 Get/Set
minutes
39 Digital Object 0x382 23 Open select Open select Obj3 BOOL 1 1 Open=1 0 Get/Set
Obj3 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
40 Digital Object 0x382 24 Close select Close select Obj3 BOOL 1 1 Close=1 0 Get/Set
Obj3 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
41 Digital Object 0x382 25 Execute Execute operation Obj3 BOOL 1 1 Execute Selection=1 0 Set
operation (enabled only in remote mode)
Obj3
42 Digital Object 0x382 26 Max ctrl Maximum control pulse length of Obj3 UDINT 4 1=0.01 0 600000 0 Get/Set
pulse s
length of
Obj3
43 Digital Object 0x382 27 Open select Open select Obj4 BOOL 1 1 Open=1 0 Get/Set
Obj4
Parameter List
(enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
44 Digital Object 0x382 28 Close select Close select Obj4 BOOL 1 1 Close=1 0 Get/Set
Obj4 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
45 Digital Object 0x382 29 Execute Execute operation Obj4 BOOL 1 1 Execute Selection=1 0 Set
operation
Appendix A
(enabled only in remote mode)
Obj4
377
378
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
46 Digital Object 0x382 30 Max ctrl Maximum control pulse length of Obj4 UDINT 4 1=0.01 2 600000 0 Get/Set
pulse s
Parameter List
length of
Obj4
47 Digital Object 0x382 31 Pos. Positive Sequence Current Line 1 INT 4 1=1A 0 0 Get
sequence I1
48 Digital Object 0x382 32 Neg. Negative Sequence Current Line 2 INT 4 1=1A 0 0 Get
sequence I2
49 Digital Object 0x382 33 Current - Current -seq./+seq. INT 4 1=0.01 0 10000 0 Get
seq./+seq. %
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
50 Digital Object 0x382 34 Current Current Phase Sequence USINT 1 1 0=Unknown State 0 Get
phase seq. 1=OK
2=Reverse
51 Digital Object 0x382 35 Pos. Positive Sequence Voltage Line 1 INT 4 1=1V 0 450000 0 Get
sequence
U1
52 Digital Object 0x382 36 Neg. Negative Sequence Voltage Line 2 INT 4 1=1V 0 450000 0 Get
sequence
U2
53 Digital Object 0x382 37 Voltage - Voltage -seq./+seq. INT 4 1=0.01 0 10000 0 Get
seq./+seq. %
54 Digital Object 0x382 38 Voltage Voltage Phase Sequence SINT 1 1 0=Unknown State 0 Get
phase seq. 1=OK
2=Reverse
55 Digital Object 0x382 39 DI1 counter DI1 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
56 Digital Object 0x382 40 DI2 counter DI2 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
57 Digital Object 0x382 41 DI3 counter DI3 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
58 Digital Object 0x382 42 DI4 counter DI4 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
59 Digital Object 0x382 43 DI5 counter DI5 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
60 Digital Object 0x382 44 DI6 counter DI6 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
61 Digital Object 0x382 45 DI19 DI19 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
62 Digital Object 0x382 46 DI20 DI20 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
63 Digital Object 0x382 47 Shot1 start Auto Reclose Shot1 start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
64 Digital Object 0x382 48 Shot2 start Auto Reclose Shot2 start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
65 Digital Object 0x382 49 Shot3 start Auto Reclose Shot3 start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
66 Digital Object 0x382 50 Shot4 start Auto Reclose Shot4 start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
67 Digital Object 0x382 51 Shot5 start Auto Reclose Shot5 start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
68 Digital Object 0x382 52 AR start AR start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Parameter List
77 Digital Object 0x382 61 Autoreclose Auto reclose on USINT 2 1 0=Off 0 Get
on 1=On
78 Digital Object 0x382 62 N> alarm Number of starts alarm BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get
1=Alarm
Appendix A
79 Digital Object 0x382 63 Motor start Motor start disabled BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get
disabled 1=Disable
379
380
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
80 Digital Object 0x382 64 Motor Motor is in start state BOOL 1 1 1=Motor Starting 0 Get
starting
Parameter List
0=Motor Not Starting
81 Digital Object 0x382 65 Motor Motor is in run state BOOL 1 1 1=Motor Running 0 Get
running 0=Motor Not Running
82 Digital Object 0x382 66 Voltage Indicates a voltage lower than the setpoint USINT 1 1 0=LOW VOLTAGE 0 Get
interrupt condition has occurred 1=OK
83 Digital Object 0x382 67 Timer 1 Timer 1 status USINT 1 1 0=Output is inactive 0 Get
status 1=Output is active
84 Digital Object 0x382 68 Timer 2 Timer 2 status USINT 1 1 0=Output is inactive 0 Get
status
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
1=Output is active
85 Digital Object 0x382 69 Timer 3 Timer 3 status USINT 1 1 0=Output is inactive 0 Get
status 1=Output is active
86 Digital Object 0x382 70 Timer 4 Timer 4 status USINT 1 1 0=Output is inactive 0 Get
status 1=Output is active
87 Digital Object 0x382 71 Voltage Voltage Status USINT 1 1 0=OK 0 Get
status 1=LOW
2=HIGH
3-LOW/HIGH
4=(OK)
5=(LOW)
6=(HIGH)
7=(LOW)/HIGH
88 Digital Object 0x382 72 Logic State of Logic output 1...8 USINT 1 1 Bit 0: Logic Output 1 0 Get
output See parameter 129 for output 9 & 10 Bit 1: Logic Output 2
states 1...10 Bit 2: Logic Output 3
Bit 3: Logic Output 4
Bit 4: Logic Output 5
Bit 5: Logic Output 6
Bit 6: Logic Output 7
Bit 7: Logic Output 8
0 = Output inactive
1 = Output active
89 Digital Object 0x382 73 CBWAlarm CB Wear Alarm 1 BOOL 1 1 0= No Wear Alarm 0 Get
1 1=Wear Alarm
90 Digital Object 0x382 74 CBWAlarm CB Wear Alarm 2 BOOL 1 1 0= No Wear Alarm 0 Get
2 1=Wear Alarm
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
91 Digital Object 0x382 75 Alarm Alarm L1..L3 BOOL 1 1 0= No Line Alarm 0 Get
L1..L3 1= Line Alarm
92 Digital Object 0x382 76 Fault L1..L3 Fault L1..L3 BOOL 1 0= No Line Fault 0 Get
1= Line Fault
93 Digital Object 0x382 77 SetGrp Set Group Common Change BOOL 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get
common 1=Group 2
change
94 Digital Object 0x382 78 Open select Open select Obj5 BOOL 1 1 Open=1 0 Get/Set
Obj5 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
95 Digital Object 0x382 79 Close select Close select Obj5 BOOL 1 1 Close=1 0 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Parameter List
103 Digital Object 0x382 87 Sync1 OK Sync1 OK BOOL 1 1 0= Sync 1 Not OK 0 Get
1=Sync 1 OK
104 Digital Object 0x382 88 SYNC1 SYNC1 Bypass BOOL 1 1 0= Sync 1 No Bypass 0 Get
Bypass 1=Sync 1 Bypass
Appendix A
105 Digital Object 0x382 89 Sync1 fail Sync1 fail BOOL 1 1 0=Sync 1 OK 0 Get
1=Sync 1 Failure
381
382
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
106 Digital Object 0x382 90 U12/U12y U12/U12y Phase angle difference INT 2 1=1° 0 180 0 Get
Phase angle
Parameter List
difference
107 Digital Object 0x382 91 Sync2 req. Sync2 request BOOL 1 1 0= No Sync 2 Request 0 Get
1=Sync 2 Request
108 Digital Object 0x382 92 Sync2 OK Sync2 OK BOOL 1 1 0= Sync 2 Not OK 0 Get
1=Sync 2 OK
109 Digital Object 0x382 93 SYNC2 SYNC2 Bypass BOOL 1 1 0= Sync 2 No Bypass 0 Get
Bypass 1=Sync 2 Bypass
110 Digital Object 0x382 94 Sync2 fail Sync2 fail BOOL 1 1 0=Sync 2 OK 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
1=Sync 2 Failure
111 Digital Object 0x382 95 DirectO1O Command DirectO1 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
112 Digital Object 0x382 96 DirectO1C Command DirectO1 to Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
113 Digital Object 0x382 97 DirectO2O Command DirectO2 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
114 Digital Object 0x382 98 DirectO2C Command DirectO2 to Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
115 Digital Object 0x382 99 DirectO3O Command DirectO3 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
116 Digital Object 0x382 100 DirectO3C Command Status of DirectO3 Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
117 Digital Object 0x382 101 DirectO4O Command DirectO4 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
118 Digital Object 0x382 102 DirectO4C Command DirectO4 to Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
119 Digital Object 0x382 103 DirectO5O Command DirectO5 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
120 Digital Object 0x382 104 DirectO5C Command DirectO5 to Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
121 Digital Object 0x382 105 DirectO6O Command DirectO6 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
122 Digital Object 0x382 106 DirectO6C Command DirectO6 to Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
123 Digital Object 0x382 107 Virtual State of Virtual Input 1 BOOL 1 1 Output inactive = 0 0 Get/Set
input 1 Output active = 1
124 Digital Object 0x382 108 Virtual State of Virtual Input 2 BOOL 1 1 Output inactive = 0 0 Get/Set
input 2 Output active = 1
125 Digital Object 0x382 109 Virtual State of Virtual Input 3 BOOL 1 1 Output inactive = 0 0 Get/Set
input 3 Output active = 1
126 Digital Object 0x382 110 Virtual State of Virtual Input 4 BOOL 1 1 Output inactive = 0 0 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Parameter List
Output inactive = 0
Output active = 1
Appendix A
383
384
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
131 Digital Object 0x382 115 Virtual Virtual outputs USINT 1 0 Bit 0= Virtual Output 1 0 Get
outputs
Parameter List
Bit 1= Virtual Output 2
Bit 2= Virtual Output 3
Bit 3= Virtual Output 4
Bit 4= Virtual Output 5
Bit 5= Virtual Output 6
Bit 6…7= not used
Output inactive = 0
Output active = 1
132 Digital Object 0x382 116 Diagnostic Potential output relay problem UINT 2 1 Bit 0: T1 0 Get
register 1 Bit 1: T2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Bit 2: T3
Bit 3: T4
Bit 4: A1
Bit 5: A2
Bit 6: A3
Bit 7: A4
Bit 8: A5
Bit 9:
Bit 10: T5
Bit 11: T6
Bit 12: T7
Bit 13: T8
Bit 14: T9
Bit 15:
No fault = 0
Fault = 1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
133 Digital Object 0x382 117 Diagnostic Diagnostic register 2 UINT 2 1 Bit 0: Trip relay 10 0 Get
register 2 Bit 1: Trip relay 11
Bit 2: Trip relay 12
Bit 3: Trip relay 13
Bit 4: Trip relay 14
Bit 5: Trip relay 15
Bit 6: Trip relay 16
Bit 7: Trip relay 17
Bit 8: Trip relay 18
Bit 9: Trip relay 19
Bit 10: Trip relay 20
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
No fault = 0
Fault = 1
Parameter List
Appendix A
385
386
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
134 Digital Object 0x382 118 Diagnostic Diagnostic register 3 UINT 2 1 Bit 0= DAC 0 Get
register 3
Parameter List
Potential mA-output problem
Bit 1= STACK
Potential stack problem
Bit 2= MemChk
Potential memory problem
Bit 3 = BGTask
Potential background task timeout
Bit 4= DI
Potential input problem (Remove DI1, DI2)
Bit 5= Reserved
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Bit 6 = Arc
Potential arc card problem
Bit 7= SecPulse
Potential hardware problem
Bit 8= RangeChk
DB: Setting outside range
Bit 9= CPULoad
CPU Overloaded
Bit 10= +24V
Potential internal voltage problem
Bit 11= -15V
Potential internal voltage problem
Bit 12= ITemp
Internal temperature too high
Bit 13= ADChk1
Potential A/D converter problem
Bit 14= ADChk2
Potential A/D converter problem
Bit 15= E2prom
Potential E2Prom problem
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
135 Digital Object 0x382 119 Diagnostic Diagnostic register 4 UINT 2 1 Bit 0: +12V 0 Get
register 4 Bit 1: COM buffer
Bit 2: Not used
Bit 3: Not used
Bit 4: Not used
Bit 5: Not used
Bit 6: Not used
Bit 7: Not used
Bit 8: Not used
Bit 9: Low AUX
Bit 10: Not used
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
No fault = 0
Fault = 1
136 Digital Object 0x382 120 Engine Engine running hours UDINT 4 1= 1 h 0 876000 0 Get
running
hours
137 Digital Object 0x382 121 Engine Engine running seconds UINT 2 1=1s 0 3599 0 Get
running
seconds
138 Digital Object 0x382 122 Start Start counter UINT 2 1 0 65535 0 Get
counter
139 Digital Object 0x382 123 Reset Reset diagnostics BOOL 1 1 Reset=1 0 Get/Set
diagnostics
140 Digital Object 0x382 124 Clear min & Minimum and maximum clear BOOL 1 1 Clear=1 0 Get
max
141 Digital Object 0x382 125 Pos. Positive sequence Current INT 4 1=1A 0 0 Get
sequence I1
Parameter List
142 Digital Object 0x382 126 Neg. Negative sequence Current INT 4 1=1A 0 0 Get
sequence I2
143 Digital Object 0x382 127 Current I - Current I -seq./+seq. INT 4 1= 0 1000 0 Get
seq./+seq. 0.1%
Appendix A
387
388
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
144 Digital Object 0x382 128 Current I Current I phase sequence SINT 1 1 ??=0 0 Get
phase seq. OK=1
Parameter List
Reverse=2
145 Digital Object 0x382 129 External DI1 External DI1 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
146 Digital Object 0x382 130 External DI2 External DI2 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
147 Digital Object 0x382 131 External DI3 External DI3 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
148 Digital Object 0x382 132 External DI4 External DI4 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Close=1
149 Digital Object 0x382 133 External DI5 External DI5 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
150 Digital Object 0x382 134 External DI6 External DI6 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
151 Digital Object 0x382 135 External DI7 External DI7 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
152 Digital Object 0x382 136 External DI8 External DI8 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
153 Digital Object 0x382 137 External DI9 External DI9 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
154 Digital Object 0x382 138 External External DI10 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI10 Close=1
155 Digital Object 0x382 139 External External DI11 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI11 Close=1
156 Digital Object 0x382 140 External Condition of External DI12 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI12 Close=1
157 Digital Object 0x382 141 External Condition of External DI13 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI13 Close=1
158 Digital Object 0x382 142 External Condition of External DI14 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI14 Close=1
159 Digital Object 0x382 143 External Condition of External DI15 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI15 Close=1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
160 Digital Object 0x382 144 External Condition of External DI16 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI16 Close=1
161 Digital Object 0x382 145 External Condition of External DI17 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI17 Close=1
162 Digital Object 0x382 146 External Condition of External DI18 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI18 Close=1
163 Digital Object 0x382 147 Event Code Event Buffer UINT 2 1 Bits 0…5 Code 0 Get
Event Code Bits 6…15 Channel
164 Digital Object 0x382 148 Event Event Millisecond And Second UINT 2 1 Bits 0…5 secs 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Parameter List
DO6 Close=1
175 Digital Object 0x382 159 External Condition of External DO7 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO7 Close=1
176 Digital Object 0x382 160 External Condition of External DO8 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Appendix A
DO8 Close=1
389
390
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
177 Digital Object 0x382 161 External Condition of External DO9 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO9
Parameter List
Close=1
178 Digital Object 0x382 162 External Condition of External DO10 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO10 Close=1
179 Digital Object 0x382 163 External Condition of External DO11 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO11 Close=1
180 Digital Object 0x382 164 External Condition of External DO12 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO12 Close=1
181 Digital Object 0x382 165 External Condition of External DO13 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
DO13 Close=1
182 Digital Object 0x382 166 External Condition of External DO14 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO14 Close=1
183 Digital Object 0x382 167 External Condition of External DO15 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO15 Close=1
184 Digital Object 0x382 168 External Condition of External DO16 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO16 Close=1
185 Digital Object 0x382 169 Device Device Status Codes USINT 1 1 Motor Running=0 0 Get
status Warning=1
Fault=2
186 Analog Object 0x383 1 Phase Phase current IL1 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL1
187 Analog Object 0x383 2 Phase Phase current IL2 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL2
188 Analog Object 0x383 3 Phase Phase current IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL3
189 Analog Object 0x383 4 Frequency Frequency INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
Hz
190 Analog Object 0x383 5 Io1 residual Io1 residual current INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
current 0.001
pu
191 Analog Object 0x383 6 Io2 residual Io2 residual current INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
current 0.001
pu
192 Analog Object 0x383 7 Zero Zero sequence voltage INT 2 1= 0 1000 0 Get
sequence 0.1%
voltage
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
193 Analog Object 0x383 8 Active Active power INT 2 1=1 -65000 65000 0 Get
power kW
194 Analog Object 0x383 9 Reactive Reactive power INT 2 1=1 -65000 65000 0 Get
power kVAR
195 Analog Object 0x383 10 Apparent Apparent power INT 2 1=1 -65000 65000 0 Get
power kVA
196 Analog Object 0x383 11 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U12 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
voltage U12
197 Analog Object 0x383 12 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U23 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
voltage U23
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
198 Analog Object 0x383 13 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U31 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
voltage U31
199 Analog Object 0x383 14 Exported Exported energy UDINT 4 1= 0 999999 0 Get
energy 0.001
MWh
200 Analog Object 0x383 15 Imported Imported energy UDINT 4 1= 0 999999 0 Get
energy 0.001
MWh
201 Analog Object 0x383 16 Exp. Exported Reactive Energy UDINT 4 1= 0 999999 0 Get
reactive 0.001
energy Mvarh
202 Analog Object 0x383 17 Imp. Imported Reactive Energy UDINT 4 1= 0 999999 0 Get
reactive 0.001
energy Mvarh
203 Analog Object 0x383 18 Power Power factor UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get
factor Range -1 to +1
(Internal range to 65000)
204 Analog Object 0x383 19 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL1 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth
voltage UL1
205 Analog Object 0x383 20 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL2 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth
Parameter List
voltage UL2
206 Analog Object 0x383 21 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL3 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth
voltage UL3
Appendix A
207 Analog Object 0x383 22 Tan phi Tan phi INT 2 1= -99999 99999 0 Get
Use parameter 853 for higher accuracy 0.001
391
392
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
208 Analog Object 0x383 23 Phase Phase current IL INT 2 1A=1 0 0 Get
current IL
Parameter List
209 Analog Object 0x383 24 Average Average line voltage UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
line voltage
210 Analog Object 0x383 25 Average Average phase voltage UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
phase
voltage
211 Analog Object 0x383 26 Phase Phase current total harmonic distortion DINT 4 1= 0 0 Get
current THD 0.1%
212 Analog Object 0x383 27 IL1 THD IL1 total harmonic distortion DINT 4 1= 1% 0 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
213 Analog Object 0x383 28 IL2 THD IL2 total harmonic distortion DINT 4 1= 1% 0 0 Get
214 Analog Object 0x383 29 IL3 THD IL3 total harmonic distortion DINT 4 1= 1% 0 0 Get
215 Analog Object 0x383 30 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL1 UDINT 4 1=1% 0 0 Get
S of IL1 (5)
216 Analog Object 0x383 31 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL2 UDINT 4 1=1% 0 0 Get
S of IL2 (5)
217 Analog Object 0x383 32 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL3 SINT 4 1=1% 0 0 Get
S of IL3 (5)
218 Analog Object 0x383 33 Min. of IL1 Minimum Current of L1,L2,L3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
IL2 IL3
219 Analog Object 0x383 34 Max. of IL1 Maximum Current of L1,L2,L3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
IL2 IL3
220 Analog Object 0x383 35 Phase Phase current ILRMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
ILRMS
221 Analog Object 0x383 36 Phase Phase current IL1RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL1RMS
222 Analog Object 0x383 37 Phase Phase current IL2RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL2RMS
223 Analog Object 0x383 38 Phase Phase current IL3RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL3RMS
224 Analog Object 0x383 39 Temperatur Temperature rise UDINT 4 1=0.1% 0 8000 100 Get
e rise
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
225 Analog Object 0x383 40 Ambient Ambient temperature SINT 1 1 = 1° 0 0 Get/Set
temperatur
e
226 Analog Object 0x383 41 IL1da IL1da demand amps INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
demand
227 Analog Object 0x383 42 IL2da IL2da demand amps INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
demand
228 Analog Object 0x383 43 IL3da IL3da demand amps INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
demand
229 Analog Object 0x383 44 IoCalc Io Calculated demand amps INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
demand pu
230 Analog Object 0x383 45 Io1 demand Io1 demand INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.001
pu
231 Analog Object 0x383 46 Io2 demand Io2 demand INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.001
pu
232 Analog Object 0x383 47 Voltage Voltage Total Harmonic Distortion UINT 2 1= 1% 0 0 Get
THD
233 Analog Object 0x383 48 Ua THD Ua Total Harmonic Distortion UINT 2 1= 1% 0 0 Get
234 Analog Object 0x383 49 Ub THD Ub Total Harmonic Distortion UINT 2 1= 1% 0 0 Get
235 Analog Object 0x383 50 Uc THD Uc Total Harmonic Distortion UINT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.1%
236 Analog Object 0x383 51 HARMONIC Harmonics of UL1 USINT 4 1 = 1% 0 0 Get
S of UL1 (5)
239 Analog Object 0x383 54 Min. of line Minimum of line voltages UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
Parameter List
voltages
240 Analog Object 0x383 55 Max. of line Maximum of line voltages UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltages
241 Analog Object 0x383 56 Min. of Minimum of phase voltages UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
phase
Appendix A
voltages
393
394
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
242 Analog Object 0x383 57 Max. of Maximum of phase voltages UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
phase
Parameter List
voltages
243 Analog Object 0x383 58 RMS Mean RMS voltage UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltage rms
mean
244 Analog Object 0x383 59 Input Input voltage UL1RMS UINT 2 1= 0 0 Get
voltage 1Vrms
UL1RMS
245 Analog Object 0x383 60 Input Input voltage UL2RMS UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltage rms
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
UL2RMS
246 Analog Object 0x383 61 Input Input voltage UL3RMS UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltage rms
UL3RMS
247 Analog Object 0x383 62 U12 U12 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
248 Analog Object 0x383 63 U23 U23 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
249 Analog Object 0x383 64 U31 U31 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
250 Analog Object 0x383 65 UL1 UL1 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
251 Analog Object 0x383 66 UL2 UL2 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
252 Analog Object 0x383 67 UL3 UL3 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
253 Analog Object 0x383 68 Cosine phi Cosine phi INT 2 1= 0.01 0 Get
254 Analog Object 0x383 69 Cosine of Cosine of phase L1 INT 2 1= 0.01 0 Get
phase L1
255 Analog Object 0x383 70 Cosine of Cosine of phase L2 INT 2 1= 0.01 0 Get
phase L2
256 Analog Object 0x383 71 Cosine of Cosine of phase L3 INT 2 1= 0.01 0 Get
phase L3
257 Analog Object 0x383 72 Power Power angle INT 2 1= 1° 0 0 Get
angle
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
258 Analog Object 0x383 73 Phase L1 Phase L1 active power INT 2 1= 1 0 0 Get
active kW
power
259 Analog Object 0x383 74 Phase L2 Phase L2 active power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
active kW
power
260 Analog Object 0x383 75 Phase L3 Phase L3 active power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
active kW
power
261 Analog Object 0x383 76 Phase L1 Phase L1 reactive power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
reactive kVAR
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
power
262 Analog Object 0x383 77 Phase L2 Phase L2 reactive power INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
reactive 1kVAR
power
263 Analog Object 0x383 78 Phase L3 Phase L3 reactive power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
264 Analog Object 0x383 79 Phase L1 Phase L1 apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
265 Analog Object 0x383 80 Phase L2 Phase L2 apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
266 Analog Object 0x383 81 Phase L3 Phase L3 apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
267 Analog Object 0x383 82 RMS active RMS active power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
power kW
268 Analog Object 0x383 83 RMS RMS reactive power INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
reactive 1kVAR
power
269 Analog Object 0x383 84 RMS RMS apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
Parameter List
apparent kVA
power
270 Analog Object 0x383 85 Active Active power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
power kW
demand
Appendix A
395
396
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
271 Analog Object 0x383 86 Reactive Reactive power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
power kVAR
Parameter List
demand
272 Analog Object 0x383 87 Apparent Apparent power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
power kVA
demand
273 Analog Object 0x383 88 Power Demand Power factor INT 2 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get
factor Range -1 to +1
demand (Internal range to 65000)
274 Analog Object 0x383 89 RMS active RMS active power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
power kW
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
demand
275 Analog Object 0x383 90 RMS RMS reactive power demand INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
reactive 1kVAR
power
demand
276 Analog Object 0x383 91 RMS RMS apparent power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
demand
277 Analog Object 0x383 92 Calculated Calculated Io INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
Io 0.001
pu
278 Analog Object 0x383 93 Fault Fault current level of I> INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
current of
I>
279 Analog Object 0x383 94 Fault Fault current level of I>> INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
current of
I>>
280 Analog Object 0x383 95 Fault Fault current level of I>>> INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
current of
I>>>
281 Analog Object 0x383 96 Fault Fault reactance UINT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
reactance ohm
282 Analog Object 0x383 97 Frequency Frequency fy UINT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
fy Hz
283 Analog Object 0x383 98 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U12y INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltage
U12y
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
284 Analog Object 0x383 99 Frequency Frequency fz UINT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
fz Hz
285 Analog Object 0x383 100 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U12z INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltage
U12z
286 Analog Object 0x383 101 U12/U12z U12/U12z Phase angle difference INT 2 1° = 1 0 0 Get
Phase angle
difference
287 Analog Object 0x383 102 Minimum Minimum frequency INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get/Set
frequency Hz
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
288 Analog Object 0x383 103 Minimum Minimum active power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW
power
289 Analog Object 0x383 104 Minimum Minimum react. power INT 2 1= 0 0 Get/Set
react. 1kVAR
power
290 Analog Object 0x383 105 Minimum Minimum apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power
291 Analog Object 0x383 106 Min power Minimum Power factor INT 2 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get/Set
factor Range -1 to +1
(Internal range to 65000)
292 Analog Object 0x383 107 Minimum Minimum of Io INT 2 1= 0 0 Get/Set
of Io 0.1%
293 Analog Object 0x383 108 Minimum Minimum of Io2 INT 2 1= 0 0 Get/Set
of Io2 0.1%
294 Analog Object 0x383 109 Minimum Minimum active power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW
power
demand
295 Analog Object 0x383 110 Minimum Minimum react. power demand INT 2 1= 1 0 0 Get/Set
react. kVAR
Parameter List
power
demand
296 Analog Object 0x383 111 Minimum Minimum apparent power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power
Appendix A
demand
397
398
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
297 Analog Object 0x383 112 15 min 15 Min Minimum Power factor INT 2 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get/Set
minimum
Parameter List
Range -1 to +1
power (Internal range to 65000)
factor
298 Analog Object 0x383 113 Minimum Minimum active power RMS demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW
power RMS
demand
299 Analog Object 0x383 114 Minimum Minimum react. power RMS demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
react. kVAR
power RMS
demand
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
300 Analog Object 0x383 115 Minimum Minimum apparent power RMS demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power RMS
demand
301 Analog Object 0x383 116 Minimum Minimum of IL1 INT 2 1A=1 0 0 Get/Set
of IL1
302 Analog Object 0x383 117 Minimum Minimum of IL2 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL2
303 Analog Object 0x383 118 Minimum Minimum of IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL3
304 Analog Object 0x383 119 RMS RMS minimum of IL1 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL1
305 Analog Object 0x383 120 RMS RMS minimum of IL2 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL2
306 Analog Object 0x383 121 RMS RMS minimum of IL3 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL3
307 Analog Object 0x383 122 Minimum Minimum of IL1 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL1
demand
308 Analog Object 0x383 123 Minimum Minimum of IL2 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL2
demand
309 Analog Object 0x383 124 Minimum Minimum of IL3 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL3
demand
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
310 Analog Object 0x383 125 RMS RMS minimum of IL1 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL1
demand
311 Analog Object 0x383 126 RMS RMS minimum of IL2 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL2
demand
312 Analog Object 0x383 127 RMS RMS minimum of IL3 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL3
demand
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
313 Analog Object 0x383 128 Minimum Minimum of U12 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U12
314 Analog Object 0x383 129 Minimum Minimum of U23 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U23
315 Analog Object 0x383 130 Minimum Minimum of U31 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U31
316 Analog Object 0x383 131 Maximum Maximum frequency INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get/Set
frequency Hz
317 Analog Object 0x383 132 Maximum Maximum active power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW
power
318 Analog Object 0x383 133 Maximum Maximum react. power INT 2 1= 1 0 0 Get/Set
react. kVAR
power
319 Analog Object 0x383 134 Maximum Maximum apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power
320 Analog Object 0x383 135 Max power Maximum Power factor INT 2 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get/Set
factor Range -1 to +1
(Internal range to 65000)
Parameter List
321 Analog Object 0x383 136 Maximum Maximum of Io INT 2 1= 0 0 Get/Set
of Io 0.1%
322 Analog Object 0x383 137 Maximum Maximum of Io2 INT 2 1= 0 0 Get/Set
of Io2 0.1%
Appendix A
399
400
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
323 Analog Object 0x383 138 Maximum Maximum active power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW
Parameter List
power
demand
324 Analog Object 0x383 139 Maximum Maximum react. power demand INT 2 1= 1 0 0 Get/Set
react. kVAR
power
demand
325 Analog Object 0x383 140 Maximum Maximum apparent power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power
demand
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
326 Analog Object 0x383 141 15 min 15 Min Maximum Power factor INT 2 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get/Set
maximum Range -1 to +1
power (Internal range to 65000)
factor
327 Analog Object 0x383 142 Maximum Maximum active power RMS demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW
power RMS
demand
328 Analog Object 0x383 143 Maximum Maximum reactive power RMS demand INT 2 1= 1 0 0 Get/Set
react. kVAR
power RMS
demand
329 Analog Object 0x383 144 Maximum Maximum apparent power RMS demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power RMS
demand
330 Analog Object 0x383 145 Maximum Maximum of IL1 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL1
331 Analog Object 0x383 146 Maximum Maximum of IL2 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL2
332 Analog Object 0x383 147 Maximum Maximum of IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL3
333 Analog Object 0x383 148 RMS RMS maximum of IL1 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL1
334 Analog Object 0x383 149 RMS RMS maximum of IL2 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL2
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
335 Analog Object 0x383 150 RMS RMS maximum of IL3 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL3
336 Analog Object 0x383 151 Maximum Maximum of IL1 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL1
demand
337 Analog Object 0x383 152 Maximum Maximum of IL2 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL2
demand
338 Analog Object 0x383 153 Maximum Maximum of IL3 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL3
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
demand
339 Analog Object 0x383 154 RMS RMS maximum of IL1 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL1
demand
340 Analog Object 0x383 155 RMS RMS maximum of IL2 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL2
demand
341 Analog Object 0x383 156 RMS RMS maximum of IL3 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL3
demand
342 Analog Object 0x383 157 Maximum Maximum of U12 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U12
343 Analog Object 0x383 158 Maximum Maximum of U23 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U23
344 Analog Object 0x383 159 Maximum Maximum of U31 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U31
345 Analog Object 0x383 160 Z12 primary Z12 primary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
impedance ohm
346 Analog Object 0x383 161 Z23 primary Z23 primary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
Parameter List
impedance ohm
347 Analog Object 0x383 162 Z31 primary Z31 primary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
impedance ohm
348 Analog Object 0x383 163 Z12 Z12 secondary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
Appendix A
secondary ohm
impedance
401
402
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
349 Analog Object 0x383 164 Z23 Z23 secondary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
secondary ohm
Parameter List
impedance
350 Analog Object 0x383 165 Z31 Z31 secondary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
secondary ohm
impedance
351 Analog Object 0x383 166 Z12 angle Z12 angle INT 2 1= 1 ° 0 0 Get
352 Analog Object 0x383 167 Z23 angle Z23 angle INT 2 1= 1 ° 0 0 Get
353 Analog Object 0x383 168 Z31 angle Z31 angle INT 2 1= 1 ° 0 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
354 Analog Object 0x383 169 Phase Phase current IL1 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL1
355 Analog Object 0x383 170 Phase Phase current IL2 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL2
356 Analog Object 0x383 171 Phase Phase current IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL3
357 Analog Object 0x383 172 IL1 IL1 difference INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
difference x Imot
358 Analog Object 0x383 173 IL2 IL2 difference INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
difference x Imot
359 Analog Object 0x383 174 IL3 IL3 difference INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
difference x Imot
360 Analog Object 0x383 175 Phase Total phase-current harmonic distortion INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
current I 0.1%
THD
361 Analog Object 0x383 176 IL1 THD IL1 total harmonic distortion INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.1%
362 Analog Object 0x383 177 IL2 THD IL2 total harmonic distortion INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.1%
363 Analog Object 0x383 178 IL3 THD IL3 total harmonic distortion INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.1%
364 Analog Object 0x383 179 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL1 USINT 1 1 = 1% 0 0 Get
S of IL1
365 Analog Object 0x383 180 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL2 USINT 1 1 = 1% 0 0 Get
S of IL2
366 Analog Object 0x383 181 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL3 USINT 1 1 = 1% 0 0 Get
S of IL3
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
367 Analog Object 0x383 182 Min. of IL1 Minimum of IL1 IL2 IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
IL2 IL3
368 Analog Object 0x383 183 Max. of IL1 Maximum of IL1 IL2 IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
IL2 IL3
369 Analog Object 0x383 184 Phase Phase current ILRMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
ILRMS
370 Analog Object 0x383 185 Phase Phase current IL1RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL1RMS
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
371 Analog Object 0x383 186 Phase Phase current IL2RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL2RMS
372 Analog Object 0x383 187 Phase Phase current IL3RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL3RMS
373 Analog Object 0x383 188 External AI1 External AI1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
374 Analog Object 0x383 189 External AI2 External AI2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
375 Analog Object 0x383 190 External AI3 External AI3 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
376 Analog Object 0x383 191 External AI4 External AI4 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
377 Analog Object 0x383 192 External AI5 External AI5 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
378 Analog Object 0x383 193 External AI6 External AI6 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
379 Analog Object 0x383 194 External AI7 External AI7 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
380 Analog Object 0x383 195 External AI8 External AI8 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
381 Analog Object 0x383 196 External AI9 External AI9 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
382 Analog Object 0x383 197 External External AI10 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
AI10
383 Analog Object 0x383 198 External External AI11 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
AI11
Parameter List
384 Analog Object 0x383 199 External External AI12 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
AI12
385 Analog Object 0x383 200 External External AI13 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 2000 0 Get
AI13 mA
Appendix A
386 Analog Object 0x383 201 External External AI14 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 2000 0 Get
AI14 mA
403
404
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
387 Analog Object 0x383 202 External External AI15 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 2000 0 Get
AI15 mA
Parameter List
388 Analog Object 0x383 203 External External AI16 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 2000 0 Get
AI16 mA
389 Analog Object 0x383 204 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 1 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>1
390 Analog Object 0x383 205 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 2 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
391 Analog Object 0x383 206 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 3 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>3
392 Analog Object 0x383 207 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 4 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>4
393 Analog Object 0x383 208 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 5 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>5
394 Analog Object 0x383 209 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 6 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>6
395 Analog Object 0x383 210 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 7 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>7
396 Analog Object 0x383 211 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 8 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>8
397 Analog Object 0x383 212 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 9 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>9
398 Analog Object 0x383 213 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 10 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 10
399 Analog Object 0x383 214 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 11 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 11
400 Analog Object 0x383 215 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 12 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 12
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
401 Analog Object 0x383 216 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 13 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 13
402 Analog Object 0x383 217 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 14 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 14
403 Analog Object 0x383 218 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 15 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 15
404 Analog Object 0x383 219 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 16 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
> 16
405 Analog Object 0x383 220 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 1 Trip=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 1
406 Analog Object 0x383 221 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 2 Trip=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 2
407 Analog Object 0x383 222 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 3 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 3
408 Analog Object 0x383 223 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 4 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 4
409 Analog Object 0x383 224 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 5 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 5
410 Analog Object 0x383 225 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 6 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 6
411 Analog Object 0x383 226 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 7 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 7
Parameter List
412 Analog Object 0x383 227 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 8 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 8
413 Analog Object 0x383 228 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 9 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
Appendix A
>> 9
405
406
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
414 Analog Object 0x383 229 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 10 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
Parameter List
>> 10
415 Analog Object 0x383 230 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 11 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 11
416 Analog Object 0x383 231 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 12 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 12
417 Analog Object 0x383 232 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 13 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
>> 13
418 Analog Object 0x383 233 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 14 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 14
419 Analog Object 0x383 234 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 15 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 15
420 Analog Object 0x383 235 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 16 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 16
421 Analog Object 0x383 236 External External Analog Output Channel 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO1
422 Analog Object 0x383 237 External External Analog Output Channel 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO2
423 Analog Object 0x383 238 External External Analog Output Channel 3 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO3
424 Analog Object 0x383 239 External External Analog Output Channel 4 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO4
425 Analog Object 0x383 240 External External Analog Output Channel 5 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO5
426 Analog Object 0x383 241 External External Analog Output Channel 6 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO6
427 Analog Object 0x383 242 External External Analog Output Channel 7 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO7
428 Analog Object 0x383 243 External External Analog Output Channel 8 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO8
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
429 Analog Object 0x383 244 External External Analog Output Channel 9 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO9
430 Analog Object 0x383 245 External External Analog Output Channel 10 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO10
431 Analog Object 0x383 246 External External Analog Output Channel 11 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO11
432 Analog Object 0x383 247 External External Analog Output Channel 12 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO12
433 Analog Object 0x383 248 External External Analog Output Channel 13 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO13
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
434 Analog Object 0x383 249 External External Analog Output Channel 14 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO14
435 Analog Object 0x383 250 External External Analog Output Channel 15 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000(6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO15
436 Analog Object 0x383 251 External External Analog Output Channel 16 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO16
437 StgProt 0x385 1 I> Enable Protection Enable BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
CurrentObject for I> 1=On
438 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 2 I> Group Setting Group Enable USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
439 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 3 I> Pick-up I> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 500 120 Get/Set
setting 1 x Imot
440 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 4 I> Pick-up I> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 500 120 Get/Set
setting 2 x Imot
441 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 5 I> Delay Delay Curve Type Selected USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC
family 1 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
Parameter List
Appendix A
407
408
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
442 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 6 I> Delay Delay Curve Type Selected USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC
Parameter List
family 2 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
443 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 7 I> Delay Delay Curve Type Selected USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
type 1 1=NI
DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
C 0.001
451 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 15 I> Constant I> Constant D UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
D 0.001
452 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 16 I> Constant I> Constant E UDINT 4 1= 0 20000 1 Get/Set
E 0.001
453 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 17 I>> Enable I>> Enable for I>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for I>> 1=On
454 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 18 I>> Group I>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
455 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 19 I>> Pick- I>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 250 Get/Set
up setting 1 x Imot
456 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 20 I>> Pick- I>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 250 Get/Set
up setting 2 x Imot
457 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 21 I>> I>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 180000 60 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
458 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 22 I>> I>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 180000 60 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
459 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 23 I>>> I>>> Enable for I>>> BOOL 1 1 Off=0 0 Get/Set
Enable for On=1
Parameter List
I>>>
460 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 24 I>>> I>>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
461 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 25 I>>> Pick- I>>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 4000 500 Get/Set
Appendix A
up setting 1 x Imot
409
410
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
462 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 26 I>>> Pick- I>>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 4000 500 Get/Set
up setting 2 x Imot
Parameter List
463 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 27 I>>> I>>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 3 30000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
464 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 28 I>>> I>>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 3 30000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
465 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 29 Idir> Idir> Enable for Idir> BOOL 1 1 Off=0 0 Get/Set
Enable for On=1
Idir>
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
466 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 30 Idir> Idir> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
467 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 31 Idir> Pick- Idir> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 400 120 Get/Set
up setting 1 x Imot
468 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 32 Idir> Pick- Idir> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 400 120 Get/Set
up setting 2 x Imot
469 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 33 Idir> Idir> Direction mode 1 USINT 1 1 0=Directional + Backup 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Unidirectional
mode 1 2= Directional
470 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 34 Idir> Idir> Direction mode 2 USINT 1 1 0=Directional + Backup 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Unidirectional
mode 2 2= Directional
471 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 35 Idir> Idir> Angle offset 1 INT 2 1= 1 ° -180 179 8192 Get/Set
Angle offset
1
472 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 36 Idir> Idir> Angle offset 2 INT 2 1= 1 ° -180 179 8192 Get/Set
Angle offset
2
473 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 37 Idir> Idir> Delay curve family 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve 1=IEC
family 1 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
474 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 38 Idir> Idir> Delay curve family 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve 1=IEC
family 2 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
475 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 39 Idir> Idir> Delay type 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI
1 DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Parameter List
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
477 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 41 Idir> Inv. Idir> Inv. time coefficient k 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 2000 20 Get/Set
time
coefficient k
Appendix A
1
411
412
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
478 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 42 Idir> Inv. Idir> Inv. time coefficient k 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 2000 20 Get/Set
time
Parameter List
coefficient k
2
479 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 43 Idir> Idir> Constant A UDINT 4 1= 0 200000 1 Get/Set
Constant A 0.001
480 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 44 Idir> Idir> Constant B UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant B 0.001
481 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 45 Idir> Idir> Constant C UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant C 0.001
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Parameter List
Appendix A
413
414
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
495 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 59 Idir>> Delay Curve USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI
Parameter List
Idir>> Delay type 2
2 2=VI
3=EI
DT=Definite time 4=LTI
NI=Normal inverse 5=LTEI
VI=Very inverse 6=LTVI
EI=Extremely inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTI=Long time inverse 9=STEI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 10=RI
LTVI=Long time very inverse
MI=Moderately inverse
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
508 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 72 Idir>>> Idir>>> Direction mode 2 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
mode 2 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
509 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 73 Idir>>> Idir>>> Angle offset 1 INT 2 1= 1 ° -180 179 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
1
510 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 74 Idir>>> Idir>>> Angle offset 2 INT 2 1= 1 ° -180 179 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
2
511 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 75 Idir>>> Idir>>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 30 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
512 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 76 Idir>>> Idir>>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 30 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
513 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 77 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Enable for Idir>>>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Idir>>>>
514 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 78 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
Parameter List
515 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 79 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 120 Get/Set
Pick-up x Imot
setting 1
516 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 80 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 120 Get/Set
Appendix A
Pick-up x Imot
setting 2
415
416
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
517 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 81 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Direction mode 1 USINT 1 0 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
Parameter List
mode 1 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
518 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 82 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Direction mode 2 USINT 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
mode 2 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
519 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 83 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Angle offset 1 INT 2 1 = 1° -180 179 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
1
520 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 84 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Angle offset 2 INT 2 1 = 1° -180 179 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
2
521 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 85 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 30 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
522 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 86 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 30 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
523 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 87 I2> Enable I2> Enable for I2> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for I2> 1=On
524 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 88 I2> Group I2> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
525 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 89 I2> Pick-up I2> K2 Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 2 70 6554 Get/Set
setting K2 1
526 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 90 I2> Pick-up I2> K2 Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 2 70 6554 Get/Set
setting K2 2
527 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 91 I2> Delay I2> Delay type 1 USINT 1 0 0=DT 0 Get/Set
type 1 1=INV
528 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 92 I2> Delay I2> Delay type 2 USINT 1 0 0=DT 0 Get/Set
type 2 1=INV
529 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 93 I2> I2> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 10 6000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
530 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 94 I2> I2> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 10 6000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
531 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 95 I2>> I2>> Enable for I2>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
I2>>
532 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 96 Ist> Enable Ist> Enable for Ist> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for Ist> 1=On
533 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 97 Ist> Motor Ist> Motor start detection current UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 130 1000 150 Get/Set
start x Imot
detection
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
current
534 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 98 Ist> Nom Ist> Nominal motor start current UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 150 1000 600 Get/Set
motor start x Imot
current
535 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 99 Ist> Delay Ist> Delay type USINT 1 1 0 Get/Set
type DT=0
INV=1
536 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 100 Ist> Ist> Operation delay UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 10 3000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay
537 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 101 N> Enable Enable for N> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
for N> 1=Enable
538 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 102 N> Max N> Maximum motor starts/hour UDINT 4 1 1 20 6 Get/Set
motor
starts/hour
539 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 103 N> Min N> Minimum time between motor starts UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 0 1000 600000 Get/Set
time min
between
motor
starts
540 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 104 N> Alarm N> Alarm on event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
on event 1=On
Parameter List
541 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 105 N> Alarm N> Alarm off event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
off event 1=On
542 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 106 N> Motor N> Motor start disabled BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
start 1=On
Appendix A
disabled
417
418
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
543 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 107 N> Motor N> Motor start enabled BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
start
Parameter List
1=On
enabled
544 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 108 I< Enable I< Enable for I< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
for I< 1=On
545 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 109 I< Group I< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
546 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 110 I< Pick-up I< Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 20 70 50 Get/Set
setting 1 Imot
547 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 111 I< Pick-up I< Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 20 70 50 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
setting 2 Imot
548 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 112 I< I< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation
delay 1
549 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 113 I< I< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation
delay 2
550 StgProtCurrentObject(1) 0x385 114 ArcI> ArcI> Enable BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable 1=On
551 StgProtCurrentObject(1) 0x385 115 ArcI> Pick- ArcI> Pick-up setting UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 5 100 10
up setting pu
552 StgProtCurrentObject(1) 0x385 116 ArcI> Arc ArcI> Arc inputs in use USINT 1 1 1=S1 15 Get/Set
inputs in 2=S2
use 3=S1/S2
4=BI
5=S1/BI
6=S2/BI
S1/S2/BI=7
553 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 117 dI> Enable dI> Enable BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
1=On
554 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 118 dI> pick-up dI> pick-up (Ibias < 0.5Ign) UDINT 4 1 = 1% 5 50 20 Get/Set
(Ibias < Imot
0.5Ign)
555 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 119 dI> Slope1 dI> Slope1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 5 100 50 Get/Set
556 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 120 dI> Ibias dI> Ibias for start of slope 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 100 300 200 Get/Set
for start of x Imot
slope 2
557 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 121 dI> Slope2 dI> Slope2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 50 200 150 Get/Set
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
558 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 122 dI> dI> dI> dI> 2.harm. block enable BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
2.harm. 1=On
block
enable
559 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 123 dI> dI> 2.harm. block limit UDINT 4 1 = 1% 6553 Get/Set
2.harm.
block limit
560 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 124 dI>> dI>> Enable BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable 1=On
561 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 125 dI>> Pick- dI>> Pick-up setting UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 50 400 200 Get/Set
up setting x Imot
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
562 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 126 I2> Enable I2> Enable for I2> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
for I2> 1=On
563 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 127 I2> Group I2> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
564 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 128 I2> Pick-up I2> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 6554 Get/Set
setting 1
565 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 129 I2> Pick-up I2> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 6554 Get/Set
setting 2
566 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 130 I2> Delay I2> Delay type 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
type 1 1=INV
567 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 131 I2> Delay I2> Delay type 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
type 2 1=INV
568 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 132 I2> I2> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 10 6000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
569 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 133 I2> I2> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 10 6000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
570 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 134 I> Enable I> Enable for I> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for I> 1=On
Parameter List
571 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 135 I> Group I> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
572 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 136 I> Pick-up I> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 500 120 Get/Set
setting 1 x Imot
Appendix A
573 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 137 I> Pick-up I> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 500 120 Get/Set
setting 2 x Imot
419
420
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
574 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 138 I> Delay I> Delay curve family 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC
Parameter List
family 1 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
575 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 139 I> Delay I> Delay curve family 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC
family 2 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
576 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 140 I> Delay I> Delay type 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
type 1 1=NI
DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
577 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 141 I> Delay I> Delay type 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
type 2 1=NI
DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Parameter List
585 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 149 I>> Enable I>> Enable for I>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for I>> 1=On
586 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 150 I>> Group I>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
1=On
Appendix A
587 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 151 I>> Pick- I>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 250 Get/Set
up setting 1 x Imot
421
422
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
588 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 152 I>> Pick- I>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 250 Get/Set
up setting 2 x Imot
Parameter List
589 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 153 I>> I>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 30000 60 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
590 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 154 I>> I>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 30000 60 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
591 StgProtEFObject 0x386 1 Io> Enable Enable for Io> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for Io> 1=On
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
592 StgProtEFObject 0x386 2 Io> Group Io> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
593 StgProtEFObject 0x386 3 Io> Pick- Io> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 5 20000 50 Get/Set
up setting 1 0.001
pu
594 StgProtEFObject 0x386 4 Io> Pick- Io> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 5 20000 50 Get/Set
up setting 2 0.001
pu
595 StgProtEFObject 0x386 5 Io> Delay Io> Delay curve family 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC
family 1 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
596 StgProtEFObject 0x386 6 Io> Delay Io> Delay curve family 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC
family 2 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
597 StgProtEFObject 0x386 7 Io> Delay Io> Delay type 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
type 1 1=NI
DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Parameter List
delay 2
601 StgProtEFObject 0x386 11 Io> Io> Intermittent time UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 30000 0 Get/Set
Intermitten s
t time
602 StgProtEFObject 0x386 12 Io> Io> Constant A UDINT 4 1= 0 200000 1 Get/Set
Appendix A
Constant A 0.001
423
424
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
603 StgProtEFObject 0x386 13 Io> Io> Constant B UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant B 0.001
Parameter List
604 StgProtEFObject 0x386 14 Io> Io> Constant C UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant C 0.001
605 StgProtEFObject 0x386 15 Io> Io> Constant D DINT 4 1= -10000 10000 1 Get/Set
Constant D 0.001
606 StgProtEFObject 0x386 16 Io> Io> Constant E UDINT 4 1= 0 20000 1 Get/Set
Constant E 0.001
607 StgProtEFObject 0x386 17 Io>> Io>> Enable for Io>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1= On
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Io>>
608 StgProtEFObject 0x386 18 Io>> Io>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
609 StgProtEFObject 0x386 19 Io>> Pick- Io>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 10 Get/Set
up setting 1 pu
610 StgProtEFObject 0x386 20 Io>> Pick- Io>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 10 Get/Set
up setting 2 pu
611 StgProtEFObject 0x386 21 Io>> Io>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
612 StgProtEFObject 0x386 22 Io>> Io>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
613 StgProtEFObject 0x386 23 Iodir> Iodir> Enable for Iodir> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Iodir>
614 StgProtEFObject 0x386 24 Iodir> Iodir> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
615 StgProtEFObject 0x386 25 Iodir> Iodir> Direction mode 1 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
mode 1 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
616 StgProtEFObject 0x386 26 Iodir> Iodir> Direction mode 2 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
mode 2 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
617 StgProtEFObject 0x386 27 Iodir> Char Iodir> Character control in ResCap mode 1 USINT 1 1 0=Res 0 Get/Set
ctrl. in 1=Cap
ResCap Res= resistive 2=DI1
mode 1 3=DI2
Cap = capacitive 4=DI3
5=DI4
6=DI5
7=DI6
8=DI7
9=DI8
10=DI9
618 StgProtEFObject 0x386 28 Iodir> Char Iodir> Character control in ResCap mode 2 USINT 1 1 0=Res 0 Get/Set
ctrl. in 1=Cap
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Parameter List
Angle offset
1
624 StgProtEFObject 0x386 34 Iodir> Iodir> Angle offset 2 INT 2 1= 1 ° 0 170 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
2
Appendix A
425
426
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
625 StgProtEFObject 0x386 35 Iodir> Pick Iodir> Pick up sector size 1 UINT 2 1 = 1±° 0 170 88 Get/Set
up sector
Parameter List
size 1
626 StgProtEFObject 0x386 36 Iodir> Pick Iodir> Pick up sector size 2 UINT 2 1 = 1±° 0 170 88 Get/Set
up sector
size 2
627 StgProtEFObject 0x386 37 Iodir> Iodir> Delay curve family 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve 1=IEC
family 1 DT= Definite Time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
628 StgProtEFObject 0x386 38 Iodir> Iodir> Delay curve family 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve 1=IEC
family 2 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
629 StgProtEFObject 0x386 39 Iodir> Iodir> Delay type 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI
1 DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
630 StgProtEFObject 0x386 40 Iodir> Iodir> Delay type 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI
2 DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
631 StgProtEFObject 0x386 41 Iodir> Iodir> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
632 StgProtEFObject 0x386 42 Iodir> Iodir> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
633 StgProtEFObject 0x386 43 Iodir> Iodir> Constant A UDINT 4 1= 0 200000 1 Get/Set
Constant A 0.001
634 StgProtEFObject 0x386 44 Iodir> Iodir> Constant B UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant B 0.001
635 StgProtEFObject 0x386 45 Iodir> Iodir> Constant C UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant C 0.001
636 StgProtEFObject 0x386 46 Iodir> Iodir> Constant D DINT 4 1= -10000 10000 1 Get/Set
Constant D 0.001
637 StgProtEFObject 0x386 47 Iodir> Iodir> Constant E UDINT 4 1= 0 20000 1 Get/Set
Constant E 0.001
638 StgProtEFObject 0x386 48 Iodir>> Iodir>> Enable for Iodir>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Parameter List
Enable for 1=On
Iodir>>
639 StgProtEFObject 0x386 49 Iodir>> Iodir>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
640 StgProtEFObject 0x386 50 Iodir>> Iodir>> Direction mode 1 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Appendix A
Direction 1=Sector
mode 1 2=Undir
427
428
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
641 StgProtEFObject 0x386 51 Iodir>> Iodir>> Direction mode 2 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
Parameter List
mode 2 2=Undir
642 StgProtEFObject 0x386 52 Iodir>> Iodir>> Character control in ResCap mode USINT 1 1 0=Res 0 Get/Set
Char ctrl. in 1 1=Cap
ResCap 2=DI1
mode 1 3=DI2
4=DI3
5=DI4
6=DI5
7=DI6
8=DI7
9=DI8
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
10=DI9
643 StgProtEFObject 0x386 53 Iodir>> Iodir>> Character control in ResCap mode USINT 1 1 0=Res 0 Get/Set
Char ctrl. in 2 1=Cap
ResCap 2=DI1
mode 2 3=DI2
4=DI3
5=DI4
6=DI5
7=DI6
8=DI7
9=DI8
10=DI9
644 StgProtEFObject 0x386 54 Iodir>> Iodir>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 20 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting 1
645 StgProtEFObject 0x386 55 Iodir>> Iodir>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 20 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting 2
646 StgProtEFObject 0x386 56 Iodir>> Uo Iodir>> Uo setting for IoDir>> stage 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 50 10 Get/Set
setting for
IoDir>>
stage 1
647 StgProtEFObject 0x386 57 Iodir>> Uo Iodir>> Uo setting for IoDir>> stage 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 50 10 Get/Set
setting for
IoDir>>
stage 2
648 StgProtEFObject 0x386 58 Iodir>> Iodir>> Angle offset 1 INT 2 1= 1° 0 170 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
649 StgProtEFObject 0x386 59 Iodir>> Iodir>> Angle offset 2 INT 2 1= 1° 0 170 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
2
650 StgProtEFObject 0x386 60 Iodir>> Iodir>> Pick up sector size 1 UINT 2 1= 1±° 0 170 88 Get/Set
Pick up
sector size 1
651 StgProtEFObject 0x386 61 Iodir>> Iodir>> Pick up sector size 2 UINT 2 1 = 1±° 0 170 88 Get/Set
Pick up
sector size 2
652 StgProtEFObject 0x386 62 Iodir>> Iodir>> Delay curve family 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve 1=IEC
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Parameter List
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
Appendix A
429
430
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
655 StgProtEFObject 0x386 65 Iodir>> Iodir>> Delay type 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI
Parameter List
2 DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
on mode
670 StgProtEFObject 0x386 80 Io>>> Io>>> Compensation current UDINT 4 1= 10 3000 50 Get/Set
Compensati 0.001
on current pu
671 StgProtEFObject 0x386 81 Io>>> Io>>> Save unbalance current USINT 1 1 1=Get 0 Get/Set
Save
unbalance
current
672 StgProtEFObject 0x386 82 Io>>> Io>>> Saving unbalance event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Saving 1=On
unbal event
673 StgProtEFObject 0x386 83 Io>>> Io>>> Unbalance saved event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Unbal saved 1=On
event
674 StgProtEFObject 0x386 84 Io>>>> Io>>>> Enable for Io>>>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Io>>>>
675 StgProtEFObject 0x386 85 Io>>>> Io>>>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
676 StgProtEFObject 0x386 86 Io>>>> Io>>>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 20 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting 1
Parameter List
677 StgProtEFObject 0x386 87 Io>>>> Io>>>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 20 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting 2
678 StgProtEFObject 0x386 88 Io>>>> Io>>>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
Appendix A
delay 1
431
432
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
679 StgProtEFObject 0x386 89 Io>>>> Io>>>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
Parameter List
delay 2
680 StgProtEFObject 0x386 90 Io>>>> Io>>>> Compensation mode USINT 1 1 Off=0 0 Get/Set
Compensati Normal=1
on mode Location=2
681 StgProtEFObject 0x386 91 Io>>>> Io>>>> Compensation current UDINT 4 1= 10 3000 50 Get/Set
Compensati 0.001
on current pu
682 StgProtEFObject 0x386 92 Io>>>> Io>>>> Save unbalance current USINT 1 1 1=Get 0 Get/Set
Save
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
unbalance
current
683 StgProtEFObject 0x386 93 Io>>>> Io>>>> Max allowed faults UINT 2 1 0 10 0 Get/Set
Max
allowed
faults
684 StgProtEFObject 0x386 94 Io>>>> Io>>>> Clear location counters USINT 1 1 1=Clear 0 Get/Set
Clear
location
counters
685 StgProtEFObject 0x386 95 Io>>>> Io>>>> Saving unbalance event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Saving 1=On
unbal event
686 StgProtEFObject 0x386 96 Io>>>> Io>>>> Unbalance saved event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Unbal saved 1=On
event
687 StgProtEFObject 0x386 97 IoInt> IoInt> Enable for IoInt> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
IoInt>
688 StgProtEFObject 0x386 98 IoInt> IoInt> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Group 1=On
689 StgProtEFObject 0x386 99 IoInt> Uo IoInt> Uo pick-up 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 10 Get/Set
pick-up 1
690 StgProtEFObject 0x386 100 IoInt> Uo IoInt> Uo pick-up 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 10 Get/Set
pick-up 2
691 StgProtEFObject 0x386 101 IoInt> IoInt> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 2 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
692 StgProtEFObject 0x386 102 IoInt> IoInt> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 2 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
693 StgProtEFObject 0x386 103 IoInt> IoInt> Intermittent time UDINT 4 1 =0.01 0 30000 100 Get/Set
Intermitten s
t time
694 StgProtEFObject 0x386 104 Uo> Uo> Enable for Uo> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Uo>
695 StgProtEFObject 0x386 105 Uo> Group Uo> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
696 StgProtEFObject 0x386 106 Uo> Pick- Uo> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 10 Get/Set
up setting 1
697 StgProtEFObject 0x386 107 Uo> Pick- Uo> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 10 Get/Set
up setting 2
698 StgProtEFObject 0x386 108 Uo> Uo> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 3 3000 20 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
699 StgProtEFObject 0x386 109 Uo> Uo> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 3 3000 20 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
700 StgProtEFObject 0x386 110 Uo>> Uo>> Enable for Uo>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Uo>>
701 StgProtEFObject 0x386 111 Uo>> Uo>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
702 StgProtEFObject 0x386 112 Uo>> Pick- Uo>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 20 Get/Set
up setting 1
703 StgProtEFObject 0x386 113 Uo>> Pick- Uo>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 20 Get/Set
up setting 2
704 StgProtEFObject 0x386 114 Uo>> Uo>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 5 Get/Set
Operation
Parameter List
delay 1
705 StgProtEFObject 0x386 115 Uo>> Uo>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 5 Get/Set
Operation
delay 2
Appendix A
433
434
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
706 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 116 ArcIo1> ArcIo1> Enable for ArcIo1> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for
Parameter List
1=On
ArcIo1>
707 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 117 ArcIo1> ArcIo1> Pick-up setting UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 100 10 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting
708 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 118 ArcIo1> Arc ArcIo1> Arc inputs in use USINT 1 1 S1=1 15 Get/Set
inputs in S2=2
use S1/S2=3
BI=4
S1/BI=5
S2/BI=6
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
S1/S2/BI=7
709 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 119 ArcIo2> Enable for ArcIo2> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
ArcIo2>
710 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 120 ArcIo2> ArcIo2> Pick-up setting UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 100 10 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting
711 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 121 ArcIo2> Arc ArcIo2> Arc inputs in use USINT 1 1 S1=1 15 Get/Set
inputs in S2=2
use S1/S2=3
BI=4
S1/BI=5
S2/BI=6
S1/S2/BI=7
712 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 1 U> Enable U> Enable for U> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for U> 1=On
713 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 2 U> Group U> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
714 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 3 U> Pick- U> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 50 150 120 Get/Set
up setting 1 1%Un
715 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 4 U> Pick- U> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 50 150 120 Get/Set
up setting 2 1%Un
716 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 5 U> U> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 8 30000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
717 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 6 U> U> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 8 30000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
718 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 7 U> U> Release delay UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 300000 0 Get/Set
Release s
delay
719 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 8 U> U> Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%
720 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 9 U>> U>> Enable for U>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
U>>
721 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 10 U>> U>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
722 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 11 U>> Pick- U>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 50 150 130 Get/Set
up setting 1 1%Un
723 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 12 U>> Pick- U>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 50 150 130 Get/Set
up setting 2 1%Un
724 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 13 U>> U>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
725 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 14 U>> U>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
726 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 15 U>> U>> Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%
727 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 16 U>>> U>>> Enable for U>>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
U>>>
728 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 17 U>>> U>>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
729 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 18 U>>> U>>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 50 160 135 Get/Set
Pick-up 1%Un
setting 1
730 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 19 U>>> U>>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 50 160 135 Get/Set
Pick-up 1%Un
Parameter List
setting 2
731 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 20 U>>> U>>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
Appendix A
435
436
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
732 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 21 U>>> U>>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
Parameter List
delay 2
733 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 22 U>>> U>>> Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%
734 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 23 U< Enable U< Enable for U< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for U< 1=On
735 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 24 U< Group U< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
736 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 25 U< Pick- U< Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 80 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
up setting 1 1%Un
737 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 26 U< Pick- U< Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 80 Get/Set
up setting 2 1%Un
738 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 27 U< U< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 8 30000 1000 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
739 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 28 U< U< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 8 30000 1000 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
740 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 29 U< Low U< Low voltage blocking 1 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set
voltage 1%Un
blocking 1
741 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 30 U< Low U< Low voltage blocking 2 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set
voltage 1%Un
blocking 2
742 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 31 U< U< Release delay UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 300000 0 Get/Set
Release s
delay
743 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 32 U< U< Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%
744 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 33 U<< U<< Enable for U<< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
U<<
745 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 34 U<< U<< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
746 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 35 U<< Pick- U<< Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 70 Get/Set
up setting 1 1%Un
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
747 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 36 U<< Pick- U<< Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 70 Get/Set
up setting 2 1%Un
748 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 37 U<< U<< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
749 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 38 U<< U<< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
750 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 39 U<< Low U<< Low voltage blocking 1 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set
voltage 1%Un
blocking 1
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
751 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 40 U<< Low U<< Low voltage blocking 2 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set
voltage 1%Un
blocking 2
752 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 41 U<< U<< Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%
753 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 42 U<<< U<<< Enable for U<<< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
U<<<
754 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 43 U<<< U<<< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
755 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 44 U<<< U<<< Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 70 Get/Set
Pick-up 1%Un
setting 1
756 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 45 U<<< U<<< Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 70 Get/Set
Pick-up 1%Un
setting 2
757 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 46 U<<< U<<< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
758 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 47 U<<< U<<< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
Parameter List
759 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 48 U<<< Low U<<< Low voltage blocking 1 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set
voltage 1%Un
blocking 1
760 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 49 U<<< Low U<<< Low voltage blocking 2 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set
Appendix A
voltage 1%Un
blocking 2
437
438
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
761 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 50 U<<< U<<< Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%
Parameter List
762 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 51 fX Enable fX Enable for fX BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for fX 1=On
763 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 52 fX Group fX Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
764 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 53 fX Pick-up fX Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 7000 19608 Get/Set
setting 1 Hz
765 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 54 fX Pick-up fX Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 7000 19608 Get/Set
setting 2 Hz
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
delay 1
781 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 70 f< f< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 30000 150 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
782 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 71 Low voltage Low (Under) voltage blocking 3rd instance UDINT 4 1= 10 100 40 Get/Set
blocking 1%Un
3rd inst.
783 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 72 f<< Enable f<< Enable for f<< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
for f<< 1=On
784 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 73 f<< Group f<< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
785 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 74 f<< Pick- f<< Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 6400 20833 Get/Set
up setting 1 Hz
786 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 75 f<< Pick- f<< Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 6400 20833 Get/Set
up setting 2 Hz
787 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 76 f<< f<< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
788 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 77 f<< f<< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
Parameter List
789 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 78 Low voltage Low (Under) voltage blocking 4th instance UDINT 4 1= 10 100 40 Get/Set
blocking 1%Un
4th inst.
790 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 79 df/dt Enable for df/dt BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Appendix A
Enable for 1=On
df/dt
439
440
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
791 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 80 df/dt Group df/dt Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Parameter List
1=Group 2
792 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 81 df/dt Pick- df/dt Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 2 100 50 Get/Set
up setting 1 0.1Hz/s
793 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 82 df/dt Pick- df/dt Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 2 100 50 Get/Set
up setting 2 0.1Hz/s
794 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 83 df/dt df/dt Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 14 1000 25 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
795 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 84 df/dt df/dt Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 14 1000 25 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
Operation s
delay 2
796 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 85 df/dt df/dt Minimum delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 14 1000 25 Get/Set
Minimum s
delay 1
797 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 86 df/dt df/dt Minimum delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 14 1000 25 Get/Set
Minimum s
delay 2
798 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 87 P< Enable P< Enable for P< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
for P< 1=On
799 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 88 P< Group P< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
800 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 89 P< Pick-up P< Pick-up setting 1 DINT 4 1= -2000 2000 -40 Get/Set
setting 1 0.1%Sn
801 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 90 P< Pick-up P< Pick-up setting 2 DINT 4 1= -2000 2000 -40 Get/Set
setting 2 0.1%Sn
802 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 91 P< P< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
803 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 92 P< P< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
804 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 93 P<< P<< Enable for P<<1 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
P<<
805 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 94 P<< Group P<< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
806 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 95 P<< Pick- P<< Pick-up setting 1 DINT 4 1= -2000 2000 -20 Get/Set
up setting 1 0.1%Sn
807 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 96 P<< Pick- P<< Pick-up setting 2 DINT 4 1= -2000 2000 -20 Get/Set
up setting 2 0.1%Sn
808 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 97 P<< P<< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation
delay 1
809 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 98 P<< P<< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation
delay 2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
810 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 99 T> Enable T> Enable for T> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for T> 1=On
811 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 100 T> T> Maximum continuous current UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 240 106 Get/Set
Maximum x Imot
continuous
current
812 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 101 T> Alarm T> Alarm setting UDINT 4 1 = 1% 60 99 80 Get/Set
setting
813 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 102 T> Time T> Time constant tau UINT 2 1 min = 2 180 60 Get/Set
constant 1
tau
814 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 103 T> Rel. T> Relative cooling time constant UDINT 4 1= 0.1 x 10 100 10 Get/Set
cooling tau
time
constant
815 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 104 T> Max T> Max overload at +40°C UDINT 4 1 = 1% 70 120 100 Get/Set
overload at Imot
+40°C
816 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 105 T> Max T> Max overload at +70°C UDINT 4 1= 50 100 78 Get/Set
overload at 1%Imot
+70°C
817 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 106 T> T> Ambient temperature INT 2 1=1° -55 125 40 Get/Set
Ambient
Parameter List
temperatur
e
Appendix A
441
442
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
818 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 107 T> T> Ambient temperature sensor selection USINT 1 1 1=ExtAI1 0 Get/Set
Ambient
Parameter List
2=ExtAI2
temp. 3=ExtAI3
sensor
4=ExtAI4
5=ExtAI5
6=ExtAI6
7=ExtAI7
8=ExtAI8
9=ExtAI9
10=ExtAI10
11=ExtAI11
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
12=ExtAI12
13=ExtAI13
14=ExtAI14
15=ExtAI15,
16=ExtAI16
819 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 108 Enable for Enable for Circuit Breaker BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
CBFP Failure Protection 1=On
820 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 109 CBFP Circuit Breaker Failure Protection Monitored USINT 1 1 1=T1 0 Get/Set
Monitored Trip relay 2=T2
Trip relay 3=T3
4=T4
5=T5
6=T6
7=T7
8=T8
9=T9
10=T10
11=T11
12=T12
13=T13
821 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 110 CBFP Circuit Breaker Failure Protection Operation UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 1000 25 Get/Set
Operation delay s
delay
822 StgGeneralObject 0x388 1 CT primary Current transformer primary UDINT 4 1=1A 10 20000 500 Get/Set
823 StgGeneralObject 0x388 2 CT Current transformer secondary UINT 2 1=1A 1 10 5 Get/Set
secondary
824 StgGeneralObject 0x388 3 I Nominal I Nominal input UINT 2 1=1A 1 5 5 Get
input
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
825 StgGeneralObject 0x388 4 Io1 CT Io1 CT primary UDINT 4 1=1A 1 20000 50 Get/Set
primary
826 StgGeneralObject 0x388 5 Io1 CT Io1 CT secondary UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 1 100 50 Get/Set
secondary A
827 StgGeneralObject 0x388 6 Nominal Io1 Nominal Io1 input UDINT 4 1= 0.1 1 50 10 Get
input A
828 StgGeneralObject 0x388 7 Io2 CT Io2 CT primary UDINT 4 1=1A 1 20000 50 Get/Set
primary
829 StgGeneralObject 0x388 8 Io2 CT Io2 CT secondary UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 1 100 50 Get/Set
secondary A
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
830 StgGeneralObject 0x388 9 Nominal Io2 Nominal Io2 input UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 1 50 50 Get
input A
831 StgGeneralObject 0x388 10 VT primary Voltage transformer primary UDINT 4 1 = 1V 50 450000 11000 Get/Set
832 StgGeneralObject 0x388 11 VT Voltage transformer secondary UINT 2 1 = 1V 50 400 100 Get/Set
secondary
833 StgGeneralObject 0x388 12 VTo VTo secondary UDINT 4 1= 25000 240000 100000 Get/Set
secondary 0.001V
834 StgGeneralObject 0x388 13 Motor nom Nominal Motor Current UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 50 20000 4000 Get
current A
835 StgGeneralObject 0x388 14 Generator Nominal Generator Current UINT 2 1 = 1V 50 65000 11400 Get/Set
nom
voltage
836 StgGeneralObject 0x388 15 Nominal Nominal power UDINT 4 1=1 100 400000 8000 Get/Set
power kVA
837 StgGeneralObject 0x388 16 Nominal Nominal shaft power Pm UDINT 4 1=1 100 400000 6400 Get/Set
shaft power kW
Pm
838 StgGeneralObject 0x388 17 Reserved Reserved BOOL 1 - - - - Get/Set
839 StgGeneralObject 0x388 18 Bus bar Bus bar nominal voltage UDINT 4 1 = 1V 50 450000 100 Get/Set
nominal
Parameter List
voltage
840 StgGeneralObject 0x388 19 Genrtr side Generator side nominal voltage UDINT 4 1 = 1V 50 65000 100 Get/Set
nom
voltage
Appendix A
443
444
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
841 StgGeneralObject 0x388 20 Connection Connection group USINT 1 1 Yy0=0 0 Get/Set
group Yy6=1
Parameter List
Yd1=2
Yd5=3
Yd7=4
Yd11=5
Dy1=6
Dy5=7
Dy7=8
Dy11=9
Dd0=10
842 Analog2Object 0x384 1 Frequency Frequency DINT 4 1 = 0.01 4500 6500 0 Get
Hz
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
843 Analog2Object 0x384 2 Active Active power DINT 4 1=1 -999999 999999 0 Get
power kW
844 Analog2Object 0x384 3 Reactive Reactive power DINT 4 1=1 -999999 999999 0 Get
power kVAR
845 Analog2Object 0x384 4 Apparent Apparent power DINT 4 1=1 -999999 999999 0 Get
power kVA
846 Analog2Object 0x384 5 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U12 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
voltage U12
847 Analog2Object 0x384 6 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U23 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
voltage U23
848 Analog2Object 0x384 7 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U31 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
voltage U31
849 Analog2Object 0x384 8 Power Power factor DINT 4 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get
factor Range -1 to +1
(Internal range to 65000)
850 Analog2Object 0x384 9 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL1 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth
voltage UL1
851 Analog2Object 0x384 10 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL2 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth
voltage UL2
852 Analog2Object 0x384 11 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL3 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth
voltage UL3
853 Analog2Object 0x384 12 Tan phi Tan phi DINT 4 1= -99999 99999 0 Get
0.001
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
854 Analog2Object 0x384 13 Average Average line voltage UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
line voltage
855 Analog2Object 0x384 14 Average Average phase voltage UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
phase
voltage
856 Analog2Object 0x384 15 Pos. Positive sequence U1 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
sequence
U1
857 Analog2Object 0x384 16 Neg. Negative sequence U2 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
sequence
U2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
858 Analog2Object 0x384 17 Min of line Minimum of line voltages UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
voltages
859 Analog2Object 0x384 18 Max of line Maximum of line voltages UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
voltages
860 Analog2Object 0x384 19 Min. of Minimum of phase voltages UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
phase
voltages
861 Analog2Object 0x384 20 Max. of Maximum of phase voltages UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
phase
voltages
862 Analog2Object 0x384 21 RMS Mean RMS voltage UDINT 4 1= 0 450000 0 Get
voltage 1Vrms
mean
863 Analog2Object 0x384 22 Input Input voltage UL1RMS UDINT 4 1= 0 450000 0 Get
voltage 1Vrms
UL1RMS
864 Analog2Object 0x384 23 Input Input voltage UL2RMS UDINT 4 1= 0 450000 0 Get
voltage 1Vrms
UL2RMS
865 Analog2Object 0x384 24 Input Input voltage UL3RMS UDINT 4 1= 0 450000 0 Get
voltage 1Vrms
UL3RMS
Parameter List
866 Analog2Object 0x384 25 U12 U12 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand
867 Analog2Object 0x384 26 U23 U23 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand
Appendix A
868 Analog2Object 0x384 27 U31 U31 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand
445
446
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
869 Analog2Object 0x384 28 UL1 UL1 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand
Parameter List
870 Analog2Object 0x384 29 UL2 UL2 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand
871 Analog2Object 0x384 30 UL3 UL3 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand
872 Analog2Object 0x384 31 Cosine phi Cosine phi DINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 767 Get
873 Analog2Object 0x384 32 Cosine of Cosine of phase L1 DINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 32767 Get
phase L1
874 Analog2Object 0x384 33 Cosine of Cosine of phase L2 DINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 32767 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
phase L2
875 Analog2Object 0x384 34 Cosine of Cosine of phase L3 DINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 32767 Get
phase L3
876 Analog2Object 0x384 35 Phase L1 Phase L1 active power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
active kW
power
877 Analog2Object 0x384 36 Phase L2 Phase L2 active power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
active kW
power
878 Analog2Object 0x384 37 Phase L3 Phase L3 active power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
active kW
power
879 Analog2Object 0x384 38 Phase L1 Phase L1 reactive power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
880 Analog2Object 0x384 39 Phase L2 Phase L2 reactive power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
881 Analog2Object 0x384 40 Phase L3 Phase L3 reactive power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
882 Analog2Object 0x384 41 Phase L1 Phase L1 apparent power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
883 Analog2Object 0x384 42 Phase L2 Phase L2 apparent power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
884 Analog2Object 0x384 43 Phase L3 Phase L3 apparent power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
885 Analog2Object 0x384 44 RMS active RMS active power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
power kW
886 Analog2Object 0x384 45 RMS RMS reactive power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
887 Analog2Object 0x384 46 RMS RMS apparent power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
888 Analog2Object 0x384 47 Active Active power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
power kW
demand
889 Analog2Object 0x384 48 Reactive Reactive power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
power kVAR
demand
890 Analog2Object 0x384 49 Apparent Apparent power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
power kVA
demand
891 Analog2Object 0x384 50 Power Demand Power factor DINT 4 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get
factor Range -1 to +1
demand (Internal range to 65000)
892 Analog2Object 0x384 51 RMS active RMS active power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
power kW
demand
893 Analog2Object 0x384 52 RMS RMS reactive power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
demand
894 Analog2Object 0x384 53 RMS RMS apparent power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
Parameter List
demand
895 Analog2Object 0x384 54 T> T> Estimated time to trip UDINT 4 1 0 4294967296 0 Get
Estimated
time to trip
Appendix A
896 Analog2Object 0x385 170 Virtual Virtual output 1 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
output 1 1=On
447
448
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
897 Analog2Object 0x385 171 Virtual Virtual output 2 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
output 2
Parameter List
1=On
898 Analog2Object 0x385 172 Virtual Virtual output 3 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
output 3 1=On
899 Analog2Object 0x385 173 Virtual Virtual output 4 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
output 4 1=On
900 Analog2Object 0x385 174 Virtual Virtual output 5 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
output 5 1=On
901 Analog2Object 0x385 175 Virtual Virtual output 6 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
output 6 1=On
902 Analog2Object 0x384 55 Phase Phase current IL1 UDINT 4 1=1A 0 2000 0 Get
current IL1
903 Analog2Object 0x384 56 Phase Phase current IL2 UDINT 4 1=1A 0 2000 0 Get
current IL2
904 Analog2Object 0x384 57 Phase Phase current IL3 UDINT 4 1=1A 0 2000 0 Get
current IL3
905 Analog2Object 0x384 58 Pos. Positive Sequence I1 UDINT 4 1=1A 0 2000 0 Get
sequence I1
906 Analog2Object 0x384 59 Neg. Negative Sequence I2 UDINT 4 1=1A 0 2000 0 Get
sequence I2
907 Analog2Object 0x384 60 Current - Current -seq./+seq. UDINT 4 1= 0 1000 0 Get
seq./+seq. 0.1%
908 Analog2Object 0x384 61 Voltage - Voltage -seq./+seq. DINT 4 1= 0 1000 0 Get
seq./+seq. 0.1%
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
909 Analog2Object 0x384 62 AI_AlarmSt AI Alarm State Miscellaneous UDINT 4 1 Bit 0: Sensor 1 Short Circuited 0 Get
ateMisc Bit 1: Sensor 2 Short Circuited
Bit 2: Sensor 3 Short Circuited
Bit 3: Sensor 4 Short Circuited
Bit 4: Sensor 5 Short Circuited
Bit 5: Sensor 6 Short Circuited
Bit 6: Sensor 7 Short Circuited
Bit 7: Sensor 8 Short Circuited
Bit 8: Sensor 9 Short Circuited
Bit 9: Sensor 10 Short Circuited
Bit 10: Sensor 11 Short Circuited
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
0=Off
Parameter List
1=On
910 Analog2Object 0x384 63 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 2
911 Analog2Object 0x384 64 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
Appendix A
of IL1, 3
449
450
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
912 Analog2Object 0x384 65 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 4
Parameter List
913 Analog2Object 0x384 66 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 5
914 Analog2Object 0x384 67 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 6
915 Analog2Object 0x384 68 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 7
916 Analog2Object 0x384 69 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 8
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
917 Analog2Object 0x384 70 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 9
918 Analog2Object 0x384 71 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 10
919 Analog2Object 0x384 72 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 11
920 Analog2Object 0x384 73 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 12
921 Analog2Object 0x384 74 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 13
922 Analog2Object 0x384 75 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 14
923 Analog2Object 0x384 76 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 15
924 Analog2Object 0x384 77 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 2
925 Analog2Object 0x384 78 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 3
926 Analog2Object 0x384 79 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 4
927 Analog2Object 0x384 80 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 5
928 Analog2Object 0x384 81 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 6
929 Analog2Object 0x384 82 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 7
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
930 Analog2Object 0x384 83 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 8
931 Analog2Object 0x384 84 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 9
932 Analog2Object 0x384 85 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 10
933 Analog2Object 0x384 86 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 11
934 Analog2Object 0x384 87 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 12
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
935 Analog2Object 0x384 88 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 13
936 Analog2Object 0x384 89 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 14
937 Analog2Object 0x384 90 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 15
938 Analog2Object 0x384 91 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 2
939 Analog2Object 0x384 92 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 3
940 Analog2Object 0x384 93 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 4
941 Analog2Object 0x384 94 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 5
942 Analog2Object 0x384 95 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 6
943 Analog2Object 0x384 96 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 7
944 Analog2Object 0x384 97 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 8
Parameter List
945 Analog2Object 0x384 98 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 9
946 Analog2Object 0x384 99 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 10
Appendix A
947 Analog2Object 0x384 100 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 11
451
452
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
948 Analog2Object 0x384 101 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 12
Parameter List
949 Analog2Object 0x384 102 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 13
950 Analog2Object 0x384 103 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 14
951 Analog2Object 0x384 104 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 15
952 Analog2Object 0x384 105 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
953 Analog2Object 0x384 106 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 3
954 Analog2Object 0x384 107 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 4
955 Analog2Object 0x384 108 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 5
956 Analog2Object 0x384 109 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 6
957 Analog2Object 0x384 110 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 7
958 Analog2Object 0x384 111 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 8
959 Analog2Object 0x384 112 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 9
960 Analog2Object 0x384 113 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 10
961 Analog2Object 0x384 114 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 11
962 Analog2Object 0x384 115 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 12
963 Analog2Object 0x384 116 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 13
964 Analog2Object 0x384 117 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 14
965 Analog2Object 0x384 118 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 15
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
966 Analog2Object 0x384 119 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 2
967 Analog2Object 0x384 120 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 3
968 Analog2Object 0x384 121 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 4
969 Analog2Object 0x384 122 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 5
970 Analog2Object 0x384 123 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 6
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
971 Analog2Object 0x384 124 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 7
972 Analog2Object 0x384 125 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 8
973 Analog2Object 0x384 126 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 9
974 Analog2Object 0x384 127 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 10
975 Analog2Object 0x384 128 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 11
976 Analog2Object 0x384 129 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 12
977 Analog2Object 0x384 130 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 13
978 Analog2Object 0x384 131 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 14
979 Analog2Object 0x384 132 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 15
980 Analog2Object 0x384 133 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 2
Parameter List
981 Analog2Object 0x384 134 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 3
982 Analog2Object 0x384 135 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 4
Appendix A
983 Analog2Object 0x384 136 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 5
453
454
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
984 Analog2Object 0x384 137 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 6
Parameter List
985 Analog2Object 0x384 138 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 7
986 Analog2Object 0x384 139 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 8
987 Analog2Object 0x384 140 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 9
988 Analog2Object 0x384 141 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 10
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
989 Analog2Object 0x384 142 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 11
990 Analog2Object 0x384 143 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 12
991 Analog2Object 0x384 144 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 13
992 Analog2Object 0x384 145 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 14
993 Analog2Object 0x384 146 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 15
994 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 147 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 2
995 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 148 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 3
996 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 149 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 4
997 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 150 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 5
998 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 151 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 6
999 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 152 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 7
1000 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 153 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 8
1001 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 154 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 9
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
1002 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 155 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 10
1003 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 156 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 11
1004 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 157 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 12
1005 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 158 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 13
1006 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 159 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 14
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
1007 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 160 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 15
1008 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 161 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 2
1009 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 162 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 3
1010 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 163 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 4
1011 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 164 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 5
1012 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 165 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 6
1013 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 166 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 7
1014 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 167 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 8
1015 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 168 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 9
1016 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 169 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 10
Parameter List
1017 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 170 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 11
1018 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 171 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 12
Appendix A
1019 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 172 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 13
455
456
Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
1020 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 173 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 14
Parameter List
1021 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 174 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 15
1022 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 175 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 2
1023 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 176 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 3
1024 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 177 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 4
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
1025 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 178 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 5
1026 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 179 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 6
1027 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 180 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 7
1028 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 181 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 8
1029 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 182 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 9
1030 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 183 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 10
1031 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 184 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 11
1032 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 185 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 12
1033 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 186 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 13
1034 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 187 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 14
1035 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 188 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 15
1100 Ethernet(3) NA NA Requested Requested packet interval time UDINT 4 1 50000 5000000 100000 Get/Set
packet
interval
time
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
1101 Ethernet (3) NA NA Controller Controller Output Image 100 Size UDINT 4 1=1 Get
Output bytes
Image 100
Size
1102 Ethernet (3) NA NA Controller Controller Input Image 150 Size UDINT 4 1=1 Get
Input bytes
Image 150
Size
1003 DeviceNet (4) NA NA Controller Controller Output Image 100 Size UDINT 4 1=1 Get
Output bytes
Image 100
Size
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018
1004 DeviceNet (4) NA NA Controller Controller Input Image 150 Size UINT 2 1=1 Get
Input bytes
Image 150
Size
(1) Only available with Arc flash option.
(2) Only used on Bulletin 856.
(3) DeviceNet not available.
(4) Not used with EtherNet.
(5) Indexed values, Bit 0 = DC component, Bit 1 = Fundamental wave, Bits 2…15 = Harmonic component active.
(6) Range and 1 = 0.01 < scaling vary by linked parameter that is selected. See publication 857-UM002.
Parameter List
Appendix A
457
Appendix A Parameter List
Notes:
Overview This appendix lists all Modbus parameters that are associated with the Bulletin
857 protection system. The parameters are listed in the numerical order of the
holding register. This table includes all holding registers. Depending on the
model and options enabled, some registers are not be available in the device.
Table 220 - Modbus Parameters
Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
Reread event 1=1 — 1 0 401991…401995 Mirror of registers
402490…402494
Events 1=1 — 1 0 401996…402000 Mirror of registers
402101…4021
05
Alive indicator (0…255 increments once 1=1 — 1 0 402001
per second)
Digital Inputs 1=1 — 1 0 402007
Dis after DI16 for Modbus 1=1 — 1 0 402008
Phase current IL1 1 A= 1 — 1 0 402009
Phase current IL2 1 A= 1 — 1 0 402010
Phase current IL3 1A=1 — 1 0 402011
lo1 residual current 1.00 A = 100 — 1 0 402012
lo2 residual current 1.000 A = 100 — 1 0 402013
Line-to-line voltage U12 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402014
Line-to-line voltage U23 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402015
Line-to-line voltage U31 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402016
Phase-to-earth voltage UL1 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402017
Phase-to-earth voltage UL2 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402018
Phase-to-earth voltage UL3 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402019
Zero sequence voltage 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 402020
Frequency 50.000 Hz= 5000 Frequency Scaling 1 0 402021
Active power 1 000 Kw = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 402022
Reactive power 1 000 kVAR = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 402023
Apparent power 1000 kVA = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 402024
Power factor 1.00 = 100 PF and cosine Scaling 1 0 402025
Energy Eexp 1=1 — 1 0 402026
Eexp/1 O^4 10^4 = 1 — 1 0 402027
Eexp/1 O^8 10^8 = 1 — 1 0 402028
There are two primary ways to connect to the relay using EtherNet I/P in
combination with a ControlLogix™ or CompactLogix™ platform using
Studio5000™ software.
1. Use a predefined static assembly in the 857 relay and apply an EDS AOP
within Studio 5000.
2. Create a custom input output assembly within the 857 in combination
with the use of a generic Ethernet module within Studio 5000.
ControlLogix
Platform with
Ethernet Interface
Ethernet Switch
Ethernet
Serial (used for initial configuration)
Configuring an I/O Profile Starting with version 13.01 firmware for the 857, an EDS AOP has been
defined to streamline the integration of the 857 within your EtherNet/IP
Using an EDS AOP network using Studio 5000 software. The use of an EDS AOP approach
provides a level of automation regarding the automatic configuration of the
input and output assembly in the 857 relay and the automatic configuration of
the tag information in the Logix environment.
To use the added functionality of an EDS AOP for the 857 relay, you must
determine which of the predefined static assemblies works best for your
specific application of the 857. The selection of the predefined static assembly
relates to the three basic criteria:
• What configuration are the devices providing three phase voltage
configured
• Is an 857-RAA RTD Scanner being used and,
• Is the protection mode either Motor Protection or Feeder Protection.
Follow these steps to install the EDS file into the Studio 5000 software.
1. In Studio 5000, click the Tool menu and select EDS Hardware
Installation Tool.
The Rockwell Automation® EDS Wizard opens.
Tools Menu
EDS Hardware
Installation Tool
3. Select the Register an EDS file(s) radio button, and click Next.
6. Click Next.
7. Verify a green check is next to your EDS file, and click Next.
After the EDS device is registered per the procedure in Register the EDS-based
Device into Studio 5000 on page 474, you must configure the device
properties to match the static assembly selected in the 857 relay.
Ethernet Bridge
New Module
3. In the Select Module Type dialog, select 857 in the Catalog Number
column.
4. Click Create.
6. In the Module Definition dialog, click the pulldown menu and choose
Static Advanced 2.
Configuring the 857 I/O No Custom AOP exists for the 857 protection relay when using RSLogix
5000®. If the 857 has firmware version13 or higher, an EDS AOP is available.
Profile Using the Ethernet /IP See Electronic Data Sheet (EDS) File on page 294 for more details.
Bridge
If used in a dynamic assembly (fully configurable), use the following steps. A
basic RSLogix 5000 Generic Profile is required.
There are four main tasks to configure the 857 relay using the EtherNet/IP
bridge.
Section Page
Set Connection Parameters in RSLogix 5000 479
Configuring the 857 for EtherNet/IP Using the Front Panel 482
Configuring the 857 for Ethernet/IP Using SetpointPS 484
Configure Produced/Consumed (CIP I/O) Image 487
Produced and Consuming Assemblies (CIP I/O) Data Table 488
Alignment
Ethernet Bridge
New Module
4. If 857 relay firmware less than release 10.96 is used, set connection
parameters as they appear in this graphic.
Connection (RPI) time in the sample program is 200 ms. An I/O connection
with any 857 relay must be no less than 50 ms. To change the RPI value, click
the Connection tab in the Module Properties: EthernetIPBridge dialog.
1. Press the info Key and enter key on the front panel
2. Enter the Relay password.
6. Set the desired IP address, subnet mask, and any other required Ethernet
attributes (specific to site network). Restart the relay.
IMPORTANT When a parameter is shown as red in SetpointPS, it means that the offline
(project file) value is set but online it is not.
4. To (download) set new values in the relay, use the icon. A restart of
the relay can be required, depending on the values that are changed. If it
is, the following dialog appears.
6. Select I/O assembly instances in use to 100+150. The relay will ask to be
rebooted again, (unless the assembly was already set to 100+150).
After the relay re-boots, the size (byte count) for each assembly is show
in this location.
IMPORTANT The producing and consuming instance sizes are shown in grey font,
indicating that they cannot be configured from this screen. The size for each
instance is dictated by the selections made in the input/output assembly.
You can configure the content of these assemblies.
It is also recommended that the Run/Idle Header selections remain with
their default values (Producing Assembly, de-selected, Consuming
Assembly, Selected).
Use the SetpointPS programming software to configure the CIP I/O image.
Scroll to CIP I/O configuration to view the image parameters. The factory
default only shows one parameter in each assembly. You must add or remove
items that you want packaged in either assembly.
The valid parameters within each assembly are selectable by clicking in the area
below the Name area and by using a pull-down menu as shown below. The
parameters can be single word, double word, or 4 word elements (8, 16, or
32 bits).
Single and double byte pad words are available as required to allow for correct
word or double-word alignment in the image.
The example below shows how the CIP I/O configuration Offset value aligns
with the single integer (SINT) array element in the controller data table.
Once the data is transferred into the Logix controller, it is recommended that
you move the data into controller defined tags for further use, such that tag
naming can identify the purpose of the data. This image uses the following tag
names to identify their purposes, and Logix 5000 instructions to transfer the
data to them.
Notes:
The following terms and abbreviations are used throughout this manual. For
definitions of terms that are not listed here, see the Allen-Bradley® Industrial
Automation Glossary, publication AG-7.1.
Altitude The atmospheric altitude (height above sea level) at which the motor is
operating; NEMA standards call for an altitude not to exceed1000 m (3300
ft). As the altitude increases above 1000 m (3300 ft) and the air density
decreases, the ability for the air to cool the motor decreases. For higher
altitudes, higher grades of insulation or motor derating are required. DC
motors require special brushes for operation at high altitudes.
Ambient temperature The temperature of the surrounding cooling medium, such as gas or liquid,
which comes into contact with the heated parts of the motor. The cooling
medium is usually the air that surrounds the motor. The standard NEMA
rating for ambient temperature is not to exceed 40 °C (104 °F).
American National Standards American National Standards Institute. An organization that develops and
Institute (ANSI) publishes voluntary industry standards in the United States.
American Wire Gauge (AWG) A standard system that is used for designating the size of electrical conductors.
Gauge numbers have an inverse relationship to size; larger numbers have a
smaller cross-sectional area. However, a single-strand conductor has a larger
cross-sectional area than a multi-strand conductor of the same gauge, so that
they have the same current-carrying specification.
Approved Use of this term indicated that the device has been found acceptable by the
authority having jurisdiction.
Authority Having Jurisdiction The entity that has authority to enforce the requirements of a code or standard,
or to approve equipment, materials, installations, or procedures.
Branch circuit The conductors and components following the last overcurrent protective
device protecting a load (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Branch circuit protection Overcurrent protection with an ampere rating that is selected to help protect
the branch circuit. For a motor branch circuit, the overcurrent protection is
required for overcurrents due to short circuits and faults to ground only (as
defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Branch circuit protective device A fuse or circuit breaker that has been evaluated to a safety standard for
providing overcurrent protection (as defined in UL 508A, December 28,
2007).
Circuit Breaker (CB) A device that is designed to open and close a circuit by non-automatic means.
And to open the circuit automatically on a pre-determined overcurrent,
without damage to itself when properly applied within its rating.
Class 1 circuit A control circuit on the load side of overcurrent protective device where the
voltage does not exceed 600 volts. Where the power available is not limited, or
control circuit on the load side of power is limiting the supply. Such as a
transformer (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Class 1 wiring Conductors of a Class 1 Circuit (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Class 2 circuit A control circuit that is supplied from a source having limited voltage (30V rms
or less0. And current capacity, such as from the secondary of a Class 2
transformer, and rated for use with Class 2 remote-control or signaling circuits
(as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Coil 1. The electrical conductors wound into the core slot of a motor, electrically
insulated from the iron core. A group of coils is connected into circuits, or
windings, which carry independent current. These coils carry and produce a
magnetic field when a current pass through them.
Combination motor controller One or more devices that are assembled to provide a means to disconnect, the
branch circuit protection, motor control, and motor overload protection for a
motor circuit. As defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007.
Conduit box The metal container usually on the side of the motor, where the stator (the
winding) leads are attached to leads that go to the power supply.
Control circuit A circuit that carries the electric signals that direct the performance of a
controller, and which does not carry the main power circuit. A control circuit
is, in most cases, limited to 15 amperes (as defined in UL 508A, December 28,
2007).
Control circuit transformer A transformer whose secondary supplies power to control circuit devices only
(excluding loads). As defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007.
cosϕ Active power that is divided by apparent power = P/S. (See Chapter 5).
Negative sign indicates reverse power.
CT Current transformer.
DC motor A motor that uses generated or rectified DC power. A DC motor is often used
when variable-speed operation is required.
DI Digital input.
Disconnecting means A device that disconnects all ungrounded conductors of a circuit from their
electrical supply (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
DSR Data set ready. An RS-232 signal. Input in front panel port of Allen-Bradley
relays to disable rear-panel local port.
DST Daylight Savings Time. Adjusting the official local time forward by 1 hour for
summer time.
DT Definite Time.
DTR Data terminal ready. An RS232 signal. Output and always true (8 V DC) in
front panel port of Allen-Bradley relays.
FFT Fast Fourier transform. Algorithm to convert time domain signals to frequency
domain or to phasors.
Feeder circuit The conductors and circuitry on the supply side of the branch-circuit
overcurrent protective device (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Field installed equipment Devices to be installed after an industrial control panel is built/ labeled (as
defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Field wiring terminal A terminal that is provided in an industrial control panel to terminate field
wiring (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Frequency The rate at which the alternating current makes a complete cycle of reversals. It
is expressed in cycles per second. In the U.S., 60 cycles (Hz) are the standard
while in other countries 50 Hz (cycles) is common. The frequency of the AC
current affects the speed of a motor.
Full-load current (FLC); Full-load The current flowing through the line when the motor is operating at full-load
Amperage (FLA) torque and full-load speed with rated frequency and voltage that is applied to
the motor terminals.
Full load torque The torque necessary to produce the rated horsepower at full-load speed.
General-purpose motor A general-purpose motor is any motor having a NEMA “B” design, which is
listed and offered in standard ratings, with standard operating characteristics
and mechanical construction for use under usual service conditions without
restriction to a particular application or type of application (NEMA).
General-use rating A rating, expressed in volts and amperes, which are assigned to a device that is
intended to control the following:
a. A load with a continuous or inrush ampere rating that does not
exceed the ampere rating of the device.
b. When AC rated, a load that has a power factor of 0.75…0.80
(inductive).
c. When DC rated, a load that is resistive (noninductive) (as defined in
UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Horsepower (Hp) 1. Unit of power that represents the amount of work done per unit of time. 1
horsepower (Hp) is equivalent to the lifting of 33,000 pounds to a height of 1
foot in 1 minute. It is equal to 746 watts.
Induction motor AC motor that has no electrical connection to the rotor. The current that is
supplied to the primary winding on the stator produces a rotating magnetic
field in the stator. This rotating magnetic field induces current in the rotor
windings. The induced current in the rotor windings creates a magnetic field in
the rotor. The interaction of the magnetic field of the stator and the magnetic
field of the rotor causes motion. It runs close to synchronous speed.
Instantaneous trip circuit breaker A circuit breaker in which no delay is introduced into the tripping action of the
circuit breaker. These circuit breakers are able to provide motor branch circuit
protection when evaluated as a part of a combination motor controller as in
31.1.1 (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Insulation 1. Material that tends to resist the flow of electric current and reduce heat loss.
2. In a motor, insulation allows high voltage in the system for current flow and
for motor torque production.
International Electrotechnical Global organization that prepares and publishes international standards for all
Commission (IEC) electrical, electronic, and related technologies. These standards serve as a basis
for national standardization and as references when drafting international
tenders and contracts. The IEC promotes international cooperation on all
questions of electrotechnical standardization and related matters. Such as the
assessment of conformity to standards, in the fields of electricity, electronics,
and related technologies.
Interrupting Rating The highest current, at rated voltage, which a device is intended to interrupt
under standard test conditions.
Inverse-time circuit breaker A circuit breaker in which a delay is introduced into the tripping action of the
circuit breaker. The delay decreases as the magnitude of the current increases.
These circuit breakers are able to provide branch circuit protection (as defined
in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Isolated secondary circuit A circuit that is derived from an isolating source and having no direct
connection back to the primary circuit, other than through the grounding
means. Such as a transformer, optical isolator, a limiting impedance, or
electromechanical relay. A secondary circuit that has a direct connection back
to the primary circuit is evaluated as part of the primary circuit (as defined in
UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
LAN Local area network. based network for computers and relays.
Latching Output relays and status indicators can be latched, which means that they are
not released when the control signal is releasing. The releasing of latched
devices is done with a separate action.
Load 1. Burden that is imposed on a motor by the driven machine. It is often stated
as the torque required to overcome the resistance of the machine it drives.
Sometimes synonymous with “required power.”
Locked-rotor current Amount of current drawn at the instant a motor is energized. It is the steady-
state current that is taken from a line with a rotor that is at standstill with rated
voltage and frequency. In most cases, it is much higher than the current
required for running a motor. It is also known as starting current.
Local HMI IED front panel with display and push buttons
Low-voltage limited energy circuit A control circuit that involves a peak open-circuit potential of not more than
42.4 volts (DC or peak) supplied by a primary battery or by an isolated
secondary circuit. Where the current capacity is limited by an overcurrent
device, such as a fuse. Or by the inherent capacity of the secondary transformer
or power supply, or a combination of a secondary winding and an impedance.
A low-voltage limited energy circuit is not derived from a line-voltage circuit
by connecting a resistance in series with the supply circuit to limit the voltage
and current. As defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007.
Motor A device that takes electrical energy and converts it into mechanical energy to
turn a shaft.
Motor rating The operational capabilities of a motor. They are specifications or performance
limits that are measured at defined temperatures.
Nameplate The plate on the outside of the motor that describes the motor horsepower,
voltage, speed efficiency, design, enclosure, and so forth.
National Electrical Code® (NEC®) National Fire Protection Association, regulations that govern the construction
and installation of electrical wiring and apparatus. The regulations are suitable
for mandatory application by governing bodies that exercise legal jurisdiction.
It is widely used by state and local authorities within the United States.
National Electrical Manufacturers A non-profit association of manufacturers of electric equipment and supplies.
Association (NEMA) NEMA has set standards for the following: horsepower ratings, speeds, frame
sizes and dimensions, standard voltages and frequencies with allowable
variations, service factors, torque, the starting current and KVA, enclosures.
Original Equipment Manufacturer The maker of a piece of equipment. For example, a machine tool manufacturer
(OEM) buys programmable controller components, sensors, and actuators. Then
integrates them with their machine tool to produce the complete system for
sale to the end user.
Overcurrent protection A device that is designed to open a circuit when the current through it exceeds
a predetermined value. The ampere rating of the device is selected for a circuit
to terminate a condition. When the current exceeds the rating of conductors
and equipment due to overloads, short circuits, and faults to ground. As
defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
Overload protection Protection that is required for motor circuits that will operate to prohibit
excessive heat due to running overloads and failure to start (as defined in
UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
PF Power factor. The absolute value is equal to cos φ, but the sign is “+” for
inductive, which is lagging current and “-” for capacitive, that is leading current.
Phase 1. Indicates the space relationships of windings and the changing values of the
recurring cycles of AC voltages and currents. Due to the positioning (or the
phase relationship) of the windings, the various voltages and currents are not
similar in all aspects at any given instant. Each winding leads or lags another in
position. Each voltage leads or lags another voltage in time. Each current leads
or lags another current in time. The most common power supplies are single-
or three-phase (with 120 electrical degrees between the three-phases).
Power The work done per unit of time. Measured in horsepower or watts:
1 Hp= 33,000 ft•lb/min. = 746 W.
Power factor The ratio of the active power (W) to the apparent power (VA) expressed as a
percentage. It is numerically equal to the cosine of the angle of lag of the input
current regarding its voltage, which is multiplied by 100.
PT See VT.
pu Per unit. Depending on the context, the per unit refers to any nom value. For
example, for overcurrent setting 1 pu = 1 x IMODE.
Qualified person A person who has the skills, knowledge, and training that is related to the
construction, installation, and operation of electrical equipment. With safety
training to recognize and avoid the hazards that are involved.
Rated horsepower The maximum or allowable power output of a motor or other prime mover
under normal, continuous operating conditions.
Service Factor (SF) 1. When used on a motor nameplate, a number that indicates how much above
the nameplate rating a motor can be loaded without causing serious
degradation. For example, a 1.15 SF can produce 15% greater torque than the
1.0 SF rating of the same motor).
Short-circuit current An overcurrent that results from a short circuit due to a fault or an incorrect
connection.
Short-circuit current rating (SCCR) The prospective symmetrical fault current at a nom voltage to which an
apparatus or system can be connected without damage that exceeds the defined
acceptance criteria. As defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007.
Suffixes to NEMA frames Letter suffixes sometimes follow the NEMA frame size designations. Some of
these suffixes, according to NEMA standards, have these meanings:
C - Face mounting.
G - Gasoline pump motor.
H - Indicates a frame having a larger “F” dimension.
J - Jet pump motor.
Y - Special mounting dimensions (see manufacturer).
Z - All mounting dimensions are standard except the shaft extension.
A - DC motor or generator.
C - Face mounting on drive end.
D - Flange mounting on drive end.
P - Vertical hollow and solid shaft motors with P-Base flange.
HP - Vertical solid shaft motors with P-Base flange (normal thrust).
JM - Close-coupled pump motor with C-Face mounting and special
shaft extensions.
JP - Close-coupled pump motor with C-Face mounting and special long
shaft extension.
LP - Vertical solid shaft motors with P-Base flange (medium thrust).
S - Standard short shaft for direct connection.
T - Standardized shaft -“T” frame.
V - Vertical mounting.
Y - Special mounting dimensions.
Z - All mounting dimensions standard except shaft extension.
Supplementary protector A manually resettable device that is designed to open the circuit automatically
on a predetermined value of time versus current or voltage within an appliance
or other electrical equipment. It can be provided with manual means to open or
close the circuit. These devices provide supplementary protection only (as
defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).
U0SEC Voltage for input Uc at zero-ohm earth-fault (in mode 2LL +U0).
UL (Underwriter’s Laboratory) An independent testing organization, which examines and tests devices,
systems and materials with particular reference to life, fire, and casualty
hazards. It develops standards for motors and controls that are used in
hazardous locations through cooperation with manufacturers. UL has
standards and tests for explosion-proof and dust ignition-proof motors, which
must be met and passed before application of the UL label.
Voltage, Nom A Nom value that is assigned to a circuit or system for conveniently designating
its voltage class.
Load 36 Menu
Load Switching 134 EDly 36
Local Fault Log 38
Control 40 Flt 36
Panel Graph 156 Force 35
Selection 238 I>> 35
Serial Communication Port 348 Ilmax 35
Local Port 252 Load 36
Navigation 30
Parameters 253 Protection Function Structure 34
Protocol 252 SCntr 34
Logarithmic Interpolation 186 SetGrp 35, 36
Logic Functions 246 SGrpDI 35
SetPointPS 246 Stage Setting Group 35
Long Time Extremely Inverse Delay 163 Status 34, 35
Long Time Inverse Delay 160, 162 t>> 35
Long Time Very Inverse Delay 162 TCntr 34
Type 36
Looped network 75 Menu Navigation 28
Minimum Definite Time Delay Start 158, 169
M Modbus
Change Scaling Factor 74
Magnetizing Inrush If2 > Simple Tester 270
Specifications 361 Modbus RTU
Magnetizing Inrush Second Harmonic O/C Bit rate 260
Stage If2> 146 Clock Synchronization 264
Manual Configuration 261
Closing 240 Initiate Transactions 260
Opening 240 Overview 260
Masking 172 Parameters 259
MasterICD 283 Simple Tester 270
Modbus TCP 268
Material 351
Configure 268
Matrix Parameters 259
Auto-reclose 239 ModbusSlv 263
Auto-reclose Running Signal 242 Moderately Inverse Delay 163, 165
Block 235
Final Trip Signals 242 Month Registers
Output 234 Parameters 217
Shot Active Signals 241 Motor Current
Measure residual voltage Frequent Start Protection 90
Line + U0 119 Motor Protection 69
Phase 119 Current Dependent Protection Functions 69
Measured Data 41 Current unbalance protection I2> 82
Values 41 Imode 69
Measuring Circuitry 345 Imot 69
Mechanical Tests 351 Motor Status 87
Run 87
Start 87
Stop 87
Mounting Instructions 367
MSTAT 88
N
Negative Zero Sequence Voltage
Polarization 93
Network Design 287
Non-directional Current Protection
Specifications 352
Non-dry Digital Inputs DI1…DI6 313
Normal Inverse Delay 160, 165
Normal Starting Sequence 89
Polarization 93 Q
Power and Current Direction 220 Quadrants
Power Calculation 218
Power Plane 220
Line-to-Line Voltages 218 Voltage/Current Phasor Plane 220
Line-to-Neutral Voltages 219
Power Consumption 346
Power Protection 360 R
Primary Scaling 224 Range Limits 47
Profibus 55 Display 47
Profibus DP 275 Illegal Value 47
Available Data 275 Set 47
Continuous Mode 275 View allowed limits 47
Parameters 276 Rate of Change of Frequency Protection df/
Request mode 275 dt
Programmable Curves 155 Definite Operation Time 134
Programmable Stages 148 Definite Operation Time Characteristics 135
Available Signals 149 Frequency Over/understages 135
Compare Condition 149 Inverse Operation Time Characteristics 136
Coupling A 148 Load Switching 134
Coupling B 148 ROCOF implementation 135
Fault History 151 Setting Groups 134
Hysteresis 149 Rated
Independent Stages 150 CT Secondary 50
Link 148 frequency fn 345
No Compare Limit 149 Phase Current 345
Operation Delay 149 Residual Current 345
Parameter list 150 Voltage 346
Pick-up 149 Voltage Un 345
Priority 148 Read-only Objects
Recorded Values 151 Settings 237
Setting Groups 150 Rear Connection
Protection
857-3C6 319
Industrial Feeder 306 857-3C7 320
Parallel Line 307 857-3C8 321
Ring Network 308 Rear Panel
Substation Feeder 305
Overview 319
Protection Functions 19, 34
Reclaim Time Setting 240
Block 66 Reclose Shots 238
Enable/disable 49
Fault Logs 38 Recorder
List 63 Trigger 173
Protection Menu 49 Relative Humidity 351
Reset Counters 49 Relay
Protection mode for f>> 132 Applications 21
Protection Stage Auto-reset Display 46
Blocked 64, 65 Catalog Number Explanation 22
Features 64 Communication Protocols 17
OK 64 Configuration 45
Setting Groups 64 Connecto to Web Browser 58
Start 64 Enable HTTP Server 57
Trip 64 Features 17
Protocol Menu 52 Firmware Compliance 19
Front Panel Overview 25
External I/O protocol 54
Information 51
Protocol Port
Operating Levels 38
Port 53 Operating Safety 19
PC (Local/Spa-bus) 53 Protection Functions 19
Profibus 55 Restart 62
Spabus 54 Retardation time 66
PT Fuse Failure 128 Set Parameters 45
Set Range Limits 47
User Interface 18
Release Time 67
Remote Selection
Control Connection Specifications 348 Local/Remote 238
Scaling 75 Self Blocking 128
Selection 238 Self Supervision 202
Remote Control 40 Serial Communication Connection 327
Remote Port X9 253 RJ-45 327
Parameters 254 ST Fiber Optic 327
Request Mode (Profibus DP) 275 Serial Number 51
ResCap 94 Service Factor 122
Directional Earth Fault Protection 96 Set Alarm Points 185
Reset Current 185
Counters 49 Operations Left 185
Latched Indicators 29 SetGrp 35, 36
Output Relays 29 SetPointPS
Time 67
Residual overvoltage stages U0>, U0>> Auto-restart 45
Blocking 56
Fault history 120 Change application mode 69
Parameter list 120 Configure FTP Server 283
Retardation Time 66 Define interlocking 49
Reverse Power 130, 131 Documentation 56
Setting Parameters 131 Download 259
Values 131 download 18
Reverse power and underpower protection P Download software 56
130 Enable HTTP Server 57
Reverse power and under-power stages P Event Buffer Size 172
Event Log 171
360 Fault Logs 38
RI Input selection 234
Inverse Delay 167 Interlocking 56
RI Inverse Time Operation 166 Logic 246
Ring Network Protection 308 Logic Functions 246
RJ-45 327, 330 LOGIC groups 57
MIMIC groups 57
RMS Values 215 Modbus Data Mappings 261
Currents 215 Motor Status 88
Voltages 215 Overview 18
ROCOF 134, 135 Read the Recordings 173
Implementation 135 RS-232 Serial Port 45
RS-232 251, 252, 259, 260, 279, 328 Run Virtual COMTRADE Files 177
RS-485 255, 259, 260, 279, 328 Set Parameters 46
Running Hour Counter 198 Single Line Diagrams 56
Virtual Input 234
Parameters 198 Setting Error 156
Runtime Errors 202
Setting Groups 37, 64
RXIDG
Example 37
Equation 166 Select 37
Inverse Delay 167 SGrpDI 35
RXIDG Inverse Time Operation 166
Shock (IEC 60255-21-1) 351
Short Time Extremely Inverse Delay 163
S Short Time Inverse Delay 163
Sags 181 Shot Active Matrix Signals 241
Scaling Examples 191 Signal Forcing Control 44
SCntr 34 Simple Tester 270
Second harmonic blocking If2> Modbus RTU 270
Modbus TCP
Measured and recorded values 146 Modbus TCP
Parameter Setting 146
Secondary Simple Tester 271
Current 78 Read Data 273
Scaling 224 Write Data 273
Sector 94 Single Line Diagram 56
Edit 56
Skipping shots 241
V
Very Inverse Delay 160, 165
Vibration (IEC 60255-21-1) 351
Notes:
Technical Support Center Knowledgebase Articles, How-to Videos, FAQs, Chat, User https://rockwellautomation.custhelp.com/
Forums, and Product Notification Updates.
Local Technical Support Phone Numbers Locate the phone number for your country. http://www.rockwellautomation.com/global/support/get-support-now.page
Find the Direct Dial Code for your product. Use the code to
Direct Dial Codes route your call directly to a technical support engineer. http://www.rockwellautomation.com/global/support/direct-dial.page
Documentation Feedback
Your comments will help us serve your documentation needs better. If you have any suggestions on how to improve this document, complete the
How Are We Doing? form at http://literature.rockwellautomation.com/idc/groups/literature/documents/du/ra-du002_-en-e.pdf.
Rockwell Automation maintains current product environmental information on its website at http://www.rockwellautomation.com/rockwellautomation/about-us/sustainability-ethics/product-environmental-compliance.page.
Allen-Bradley, CompactLogix, ControlLogix, DeviceLogix, RS Logix 5000, Rockwell Automation, Rockwell Software, RSLinx, RSNetWorx, Stratix. and Studio 5000 are trademarks of Rockwell Automation, Inc.
Trademarks not belonging to Rockwell Automation are property of their respective companies.
Rockwell Otomasyon Ticaret A.Ş., Kar Plaza İş Merkezi E Blok Kat:6 34752 İçerenköy, İstanbul, Tel: +90 (216) 5698400